Create $(infodir) before trying to install info files.
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
CommitLineData
c906108c
SS
1\input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2@c Copyright 1988-1999
3@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4@c
5@c %**start of header
6@c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
7@c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
8@setfilename gdb.info
9@c
10@include gdb-cfg.texi
11@c
c906108c 12@settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
13@setchapternewpage odd
14@c %**end of header
15
16@iftex
17@c @smallbook
18@c @cropmarks
19@end iftex
20
21@finalout
22@syncodeindex ky cp
23
24@c readline appendices use @vindex
25@syncodeindex vr cp
26
27@c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
28@set EDITION Seventh
29
30@c !!set GDB manual's revision date
31@set DATE February 1999
32
33@c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO-2 macros and info-makers to format properly.
34
c906108c
SS
35@c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
36@c manuals to an info tree. zoo@cygnus.com is developing this facility.
96a2c332
SS
37@dircategory Programming & development tools.
38@direntry
c906108c 39* Gdb: (gdb). The @sc{gnu} debugger.
96a2c332
SS
40@end direntry
41
c906108c
SS
42@ifinfo
43This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
44
45
46This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE},
47of @cite{Debugging with @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger}
48for @value{GDBN} Version @value{GDBVN}.
49
50Copyright (C) 1988-1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
51
52Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of
53this manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice
54are preserved on all copies.
55
56@ignore
57Permission is granted to process this file through TeX and print the
58results, provided the printed document carries copying permission
59notice identical to this one except for the removal of this paragraph
60(this paragraph not being relevant to the printed manual).
61
62@end ignore
63Permission is granted to copy and distribute modified versions of this
64manual under the conditions for verbatim copying, provided also that the
65entire resulting derived work is distributed under the terms of a
66permission notice identical to this one.
67
68Permission is granted to copy and distribute translations of this manual
69into another language, under the above conditions for modified versions.
70@end ifinfo
71
72@titlepage
73@title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
74@subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
c906108c 75@sp 1
c906108c
SS
76@subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
77@subtitle @value{DATE}
78@author Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch
c906108c 79@page
c906108c
SS
80@tex
81{\parskip=0pt
53a5351d 82\hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
c906108c
SS
83\hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
84\hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
85}
86@end tex
53a5351d
JM
87
88@c ISBN seems to be wrong...
c906108c
SS
89
90@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
91Copyright @copyright{} 1988-1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
92@sp 2
c906108c
SS
93Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
9459 Temple Place - Suite 330, @*
95Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA @*
96Printed copies are available for $20 each. @*
97ISBN 1-882114-11-6 @*
c906108c
SS
98
99Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of
100this manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice
101are preserved on all copies.
102
103Permission is granted to copy and distribute modified versions of this
104manual under the conditions for verbatim copying, provided also that the
105entire resulting derived work is distributed under the terms of a
106permission notice identical to this one.
107
108Permission is granted to copy and distribute translations of this manual
109into another language, under the above conditions for modified versions.
110@end titlepage
111@page
112
96a2c332 113@ifnottex
53a5351d 114@node Top
c906108c
SS
115@top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
116
117This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
118
119This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE}, for @value{GDBN} Version
120@value{GDBVN}.
121
122Copyright (C) 1988-1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
123@menu
124* Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
c906108c 125* Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
c906108c
SS
126
127* Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
128* Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
129* Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
130* Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
131* Stack:: Examining the stack
132* Source:: Examining source files
133* Data:: Examining data
c906108c 134
7a292a7a 135* Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
c906108c
SS
136
137* Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
138* Altering:: Altering execution
139* GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
140* Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
104c1213 141* Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
c906108c
SS
142* Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
143* Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
c906108c 144* Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
d700128c 145* Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotations interface.
c906108c
SS
146
147* GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
c906108c 148* Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
c906108c
SS
149
150* Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
151* Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
152* Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
153* Index:: Index
c906108c
SS
154@end menu
155
96a2c332 156@end ifnottex
c906108c 157
53a5351d 158@node Summary
c906108c
SS
159@unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
160
161The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
162going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
163program was doing at the moment it crashed.
164
165@value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
166these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
167
168@itemize @bullet
169@item
170Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
171
172@item
173Make your program stop on specified conditions.
174
175@item
176Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
177
178@item
179Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
180effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
181@end itemize
182
cce74817 183You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C++.
c906108c 184For more information, see @ref{Support,,Supported languages}.
c906108c
SS
185For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
186
cce74817
JM
187@cindex Chill
188@cindex Modula-2
c906108c 189Support for Modula-2 and Chill is partial. For information on Modula-2,
cce74817 190see @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}. For information on Chill, see @ref{Chill}.
c906108c 191
cce74817
JM
192@cindex Pascal
193Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
194nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
195entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
196syntax.
c906108c 197
c906108c
SS
198@cindex Fortran
199@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
53a5351d 200it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
cce74817 201underscore.
c906108c 202
c906108c
SS
203@menu
204* Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
205* Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
206@end menu
207
53a5351d 208@node Free Software
c906108c
SS
209@unnumberedsec Free software
210
211@value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
212General Public License
213(GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
214program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
215freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
216the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
217Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
218Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
219
220Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
221you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
222from anyone else.
223
53a5351d 224@node Contributors
96a2c332
SS
225@unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
226
227Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
228other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
229development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
230of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
231to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
232file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
c906108c
SS
233blow-by-blow account.
234
235Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
236
237@quotation
238@emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
239or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
240omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
241@end quotation
242
243So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
244particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
245releases:
246Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
247Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
248Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
249Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
250Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
251John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
252Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
253and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
254
255Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
256Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
257
96a2c332
SS
258Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C++ support in
259@value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
260Bothner. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C++ demangler. Early work on
261C++ was by Peter TerMaat (who also did much general update work leading
262to release 3.0).
c906108c
SS
263
264@value{GDBN} 4 uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
265object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
266Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
267
268David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
269the original support for encapsulated COFF.
270
271Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
272
273Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
274Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
275support.
276Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
277Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
278Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
279David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
280Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
281Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
282Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
283Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
284Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
285Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
286Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
287Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
288Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
289Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
290Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
291
292Andreas Schwab contributed M68K Linux support.
293
294Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
295libraries.
296
297Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
298about several machine instruction sets.
299
300Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
301remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
302contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
303and RDI targets, respectively.
304
305Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
306command-line editing and command history.
307
7a292a7a
SS
308Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
309Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
c906108c
SS
310
311Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
c906108c
SS
312He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C++ overloaded
313symbols.
c906108c
SS
314
315Hitachi America, Ltd. sponsored the support for H8/300, H8/500, and
316Super-H processors.
317
318NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
319
320Mitsubishi sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D processors.
321
322Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
323
324Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
325
96a2c332 326Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
c906108c
SS
327
328Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
329watchpoints.
330
331Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
332
333Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
334
335Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
96a2c332 336nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
337
338The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
339support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
340(narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC++
341compiler, and the terminal user interface: Ben Krepp, Richard Title,
342John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann, Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve
343Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase provided HP-specific
344information in this manual.
345
96a2c332
SS
346Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
347development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
2df3850c
JM
348fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
349Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
350Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
351Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
352Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
353addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
354JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
355Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
356Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
357Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
358Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
359Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
360Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
c906108c
SS
361
362
53a5351d 363@node Sample Session
c906108c
SS
364@chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
365
366You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
367However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
368debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
369
370@iftex
371In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
372to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
373@end iftex
374
375@c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
376@c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
377
378One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
379processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
380quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
381definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
382session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
383then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
384same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
385@code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
386procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
387
388@smallexample
389$ @b{cd gnu/m4}
390$ @b{./m4}
391@b{define(foo,0000)}
392
393@b{foo}
3940000
395@b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
396
397@b{bar}
3980000
399@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
400
401@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
402@b{baz}
403@b{C-d}
404m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
405@end smallexample
406
407@noindent
408Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
409
c906108c
SS
410@smallexample
411$ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
412@c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
413@c FIXME... format to come out better.
414@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
415 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
416 the conditions.
417There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
418 for details.
419
420@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
421(@value{GDBP})
422@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
423
424@noindent
425@value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
426rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
427We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
428that examples fit in this manual.
429
430@smallexample
431(@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
432@end smallexample
433
434@noindent
435We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
436Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
437@code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
438@code{break} command.
439
440@smallexample
441(@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
442Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
443@end smallexample
444
445@noindent
446Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
447control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
448subroutine, the program runs as usual:
449
450@smallexample
451(@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
452Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
453@b{define(foo,0000)}
454
455@b{foo}
4560000
457@end smallexample
458
459@noindent
460To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
461suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
462context where it stops.
463
464@smallexample
465@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
466
467Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
468 at builtin.c:879
469879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
470@end smallexample
471
472@noindent
473Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
474the next line of the current function.
475
476@smallexample
477(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
478882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
479 : nil,
480@end smallexample
481
482@noindent
483@code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
484by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
485@code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
486subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
487
488@smallexample
489(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
490set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
491 at input.c:530
492530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
493@end smallexample
494
495@noindent
496The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
497suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
498shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
499command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
500in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
501stack frame for each active subroutine.
502
503@smallexample
504(@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
505#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
506 at input.c:530
507#1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
508 at builtin.c:882
509#2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
510#3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
511 at macro.c:71
512#4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
513#5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
514@end smallexample
515
516@noindent
517We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
518times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
519falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
520
521@smallexample
522(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
5230x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
524(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
5250x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
526def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
527(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
528536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
529 : xstrdup(rq);
530(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
531538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
532@end smallexample
533
534@noindent
535The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
536@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
537and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
538(@code{print}) to see their values.
539
540@smallexample
541(@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
542$1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
543(@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
544$2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
545@end smallexample
546
547@noindent
548@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
549To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
550surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
551
552@smallexample
553(@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
554533 xfree(rquote);
555534
556535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
557 : xstrdup (lq);
558536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
559 : xstrdup (rq);
560537
561538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
562539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
563540 @}
564541
565542 void
566@end smallexample
567
568@noindent
569Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
570@code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
571
572@smallexample
573(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
574539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
575(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
576540 @}
577(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
578$3 = 9
579(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
580$4 = 7
581@end smallexample
582
583@noindent
584That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
585@code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
586@code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
587the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
588any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
589assignments.
590
591@smallexample
592(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
593$5 = 7
594(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
595$6 = 9
596@end smallexample
597
598@noindent
599Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
600@code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
601executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
602example that caused trouble initially:
603
604@smallexample
605(@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
606Continuing.
607
608@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
609
610baz
6110000
612@end smallexample
613
614@noindent
615Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
616problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
617lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
618
619@smallexample
620@b{C-d}
621Program exited normally.
622@end smallexample
623
624@noindent
625The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
626indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
627session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
628
629@smallexample
630(@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
631@end smallexample
c906108c 632
53a5351d 633@node Invocation
c906108c
SS
634@chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
635
636This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
637The essentials are:
638@itemize @bullet
639@item
53a5351d 640type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
641@item
642type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{C-d} to exit.
643@end itemize
644
645@menu
646* Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
647* Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
648* Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
649@end menu
650
53a5351d 651@node Invoking GDB
c906108c
SS
652@section Invoking @value{GDBN}
653
c906108c
SS
654Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
655@value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
656
657You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
658to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
659
c906108c
SS
660The command-line options described here are designed
661to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
662options may effectively be unavailable.
c906108c
SS
663
664The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
665specifying an executable program:
666
667@example
668@value{GDBP} @var{program}
669@end example
670
c906108c
SS
671@noindent
672You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
673specified:
674
675@example
676@value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
677@end example
678
679You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
680to debug a running process:
681
682@example
683@value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
684@end example
685
686@noindent
687would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
688named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
689
c906108c 690Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
2df3850c
JM
691complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
692debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
693``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
694will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
c906108c 695
96a2c332 696You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
c906108c
SS
697@value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
698
699@smallexample
700@value{GDBP} -silent
701@end smallexample
702
703@noindent
704You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
705options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
706
707@noindent
708Type
709
710@example
711@value{GDBP} -help
712@end example
713
714@noindent
715to display all available options and briefly describe their use
716(@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
717
718All options and command line arguments you give are processed
719in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
720@samp{-x} option is used.
721
722
723@menu
c906108c
SS
724* File Options:: Choosing files
725* Mode Options:: Choosing modes
726@end menu
727
c906108c
SS
728@node File Options
729@subsection Choosing files
730
2df3850c 731When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
c906108c
SS
732specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
733the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
734@samp{-c} options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the first argument
735that does not have an associated option flag as equivalent to the
736@samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the second argument
737that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as equivalent to
738the @samp{-c} option followed by that argument.)
7a292a7a
SS
739
740If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
741such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
742argument and ignore it.
c906108c
SS
743
744Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
745following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
746them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
747(If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
748than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
749
d700128c
EZ
750@c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
751@c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
752@c it.
753
c906108c
SS
754@table @code
755@item -symbols @var{file}
756@itemx -s @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
757@cindex @code{--symbols}
758@cindex @code{-s}
c906108c
SS
759Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
760
761@item -exec @var{file}
762@itemx -e @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
763@cindex @code{--exec}
764@cindex @code{-e}
7a292a7a
SS
765Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
766and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
c906108c
SS
767
768@item -se @var{file}
d700128c 769@cindex @code{--se}
c906108c
SS
770Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
771file.
772
c906108c
SS
773@item -core @var{file}
774@itemx -c @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
775@cindex @code{--core}
776@cindex @code{-c}
c906108c
SS
777Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
778
779@item -c @var{number}
780Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command
781(unless there is a file in core-dump format named @var{number}, in which
782case @samp{-c} specifies that file as a core dump to read).
c906108c
SS
783
784@item -command @var{file}
785@itemx -x @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
786@cindex @code{--command}
787@cindex @code{-x}
c906108c
SS
788Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
789Files,, Command files}.
790
791@item -directory @var{directory}
792@itemx -d @var{directory}
d700128c
EZ
793@cindex @code{--directory}
794@cindex @code{-d}
c906108c
SS
795Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
796
c906108c
SS
797@item -m
798@itemx -mapped
d700128c
EZ
799@cindex @code{--mapped}
800@cindex @code{-m}
c906108c
SS
801@emph{Warning: this option depends on operating system facilities that are not
802supported on all systems.}@*
803If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the @code{mmap}
804system call, you can use this option
805to have @value{GDBN} write the symbols from your
806program into a reusable file in the current directory. If the program you are debugging is
96a2c332 807called @file{/tmp/fred}, the mapped symbol file is @file{/tmp/fred.syms}.
c906108c
SS
808Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions notice the presence of this file,
809and can quickly map in symbol information from it, rather than reading
810the symbol table from the executable program.
811
812The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where @value{GDBN}
813is run. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN} symbol
814table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c 815
c906108c
SS
816@item -r
817@itemx -readnow
d700128c
EZ
818@cindex @code{--readnow}
819@cindex @code{-r}
c906108c
SS
820Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
821the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
822This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
53a5351d 823
c906108c
SS
824@end table
825
2df3850c 826You typically combine the @code{-mapped} and @code{-readnow} options in
c906108c 827order to build a @file{.syms} file that contains complete symbol
2df3850c
JM
828information. (@xref{Files,,Commands to specify files}, for information
829on @file{.syms} files.) A simple @value{GDBN} invocation to do nothing
830but build a @file{.syms} file for future use is:
c906108c
SS
831
832@example
2df3850c 833gdb -batch -nx -mapped -readnow programname
c906108c 834@end example
c906108c 835
53a5351d 836@node Mode Options
c906108c
SS
837@subsection Choosing modes
838
839You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
840batch mode or quiet mode.
841
842@table @code
843@item -nx
844@itemx -n
d700128c
EZ
845@cindex @code{--nx}
846@cindex @code{-n}
2df3850c
JM
847Do not execute commands found in any initialization files (normally
848called @file{.gdbinit}, or @file{gdb.ini} on PCs). Normally,
849@value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
850options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
851files}.
c906108c
SS
852
853@item -quiet
d700128c 854@itemx -silent
c906108c 855@itemx -q
d700128c
EZ
856@cindex @code{--quiet}
857@cindex @code{--silent}
858@cindex @code{-q}
c906108c
SS
859``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
860messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
861
862@item -batch
d700128c 863@cindex @code{--batch}
c906108c
SS
864Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
865command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
866initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
867nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
868in the command files.
869
2df3850c
JM
870Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
871example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
872make this more useful, the message
c906108c
SS
873
874@example
875Program exited normally.
876@end example
877
878@noindent
2df3850c
JM
879(which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
880@value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
881mode.
882
883@item -nowindows
884@itemx -nw
d700128c
EZ
885@cindex @code{--nowindows}
886@cindex @code{-nw}
2df3850c 887``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
96a2c332 888(GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
2df3850c
JM
889interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
890
891@item -windows
892@itemx -w
d700128c
EZ
893@cindex @code{--windows}
894@cindex @code{-w}
2df3850c
JM
895If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
896used if possible.
c906108c
SS
897
898@item -cd @var{directory}
d700128c 899@cindex @code{--cd}
c906108c
SS
900Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
901instead of the current directory.
902
c906108c
SS
903@item -fullname
904@itemx -f
d700128c
EZ
905@cindex @code{--fullname}
906@cindex @code{-f}
7a292a7a
SS
907@sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
908subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
909number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
910displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
911recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
912the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
913and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
914@samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
915frame.
c906108c 916
d700128c
EZ
917@item -epoch
918@cindex @code{--epoch}
919The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
920@value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
921routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
922separate window.
923
924@item -annotate @var{level}
925@cindex @code{--annotate}
926This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
927effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
928(@pxref{Annotations}).
929Annotation level controls how much information does @value{GDBN} print
930together with its prompt, values of expressions, source lines, and other
931types of output. Level 0 is the normal, level 1 is for use when
932@value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 2 is the
933maximum annotation suitable for programs that control @value{GDBN}.
934
935@item -async
936@cindex @code{--async}
937Use the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
938@value{GDBN} processes all events, such as user keyboard input, via a
939special event loop. This allows @value{GDBN} to accept and process user
940commands in parallel with the debugged process being
941run@footnote{@value{GDBN} built with @sc{djgpp} tools for
942MS-DOS/MS-Windows supports this mode of operation, but the event loop is
943suspended when the debuggee runs.}, so you don't need to wait for
944control to return to @value{GDBN} before you type the next command.
945(@emph{Note:} as of version 5.0, the target side of the asynchronous
946operation is not yet in place, so @samp{-async} does not work fully
947yet.)
948@c FIXME: when the target side of the event loop is done, the above NOTE
949@c should be removed.
950
951When the standard input is connected to a terminal device, @value{GDBN}
952uses the asynchronous event loop by default, unless disabled by the
953@samp{-noasync} option.
954
955@item -noasync
956@cindex @code{--noasync}
957Disable the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
958
2df3850c
JM
959@item -baud @var{bps}
960@itemx -b @var{bps}
d700128c
EZ
961@cindex @code{--baud}
962@cindex @code{-b}
c906108c
SS
963Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
964interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
c906108c
SS
965
966@item -tty @var{device}
d700128c
EZ
967@itemx -t @var{device}
968@cindex @code{--tty}
969@cindex @code{-t}
c906108c
SS
970Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
971@c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
c906108c 972
53a5351d
JM
973@c resolve the situation of these eventually
974@c @item -tui
d700128c 975@c @cindex @code{--tui}
53a5351d
JM
976@c Use a Terminal User Interface. For information, use your Web browser to
977@c read the file @file{TUI.html}, which is usually installed in the
978@c directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX systems. Do not use
979@c this option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (see @pxref{Emacs, ,Using
980@c @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
981
982@c @item -xdb
d700128c 983@c @cindex @code{--xdb}
53a5351d
JM
984@c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
985@c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
986@c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
987@c systems.
988
d700128c
EZ
989@item -interpreter @var{interp}
990@cindex @code{--interpreter}
991Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
992program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
993communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end. For example,
994@samp{--interpreter=mi} causes @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{gdbmi
995interface}.
996@c FIXME: There should be an @xref here to the GDB/MI docs, but
997@c gdbmi.texi doesn't have a single node to reference!
998
999@item -write
1000@cindex @code{--write}
1001Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1002is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1003(@pxref{Patching}).
1004
1005@item -statistics
1006@cindex @code{--statistics}
1007This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1008memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1009
1010@item -version
1011@cindex @code{--version}
1012This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1013no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1014
c906108c
SS
1015@end table
1016
53a5351d 1017@node Quitting GDB
c906108c
SS
1018@section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1019@cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1020@cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1021
1022@table @code
1023@kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1024@kindex q
96a2c332
SS
1025@item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1026@itemx q
1027To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1028@code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{C-d}). If you
1029do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1030otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1031error code.
c906108c
SS
1032@end table
1033
1034@cindex interrupt
1035An interrupt (often @kbd{C-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1036terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1037returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1038character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1039until a time when it is safe.
1040
c906108c
SS
1041If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1042device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1043(@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running process}).
c906108c 1044
53a5351d 1045@node Shell Commands
c906108c
SS
1046@section Shell commands
1047
1048If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1049debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1050just use the @code{shell} command.
1051
1052@table @code
1053@kindex shell
1054@cindex shell escape
1055@item shell @var{command string}
1056Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
c906108c 1057If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
d4f3574e
SS
1058shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1059(@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
c906108c
SS
1060@end table
1061
1062The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1063You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1064@value{GDBN}:
1065
1066@table @code
1067@kindex make
1068@cindex calling make
1069@item make @var{make-args}
1070Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1071arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1072@end table
1073
53a5351d 1074@node Commands
c906108c
SS
1075@chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1076
1077You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1078name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1079@value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1080key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1081show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1082
1083@menu
1084* Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1085* Completion:: Command completion
1086* Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1087@end menu
1088
53a5351d 1089@node Command Syntax
c906108c
SS
1090@section Command syntax
1091
1092A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1093how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1094arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1095command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1096step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
96a2c332 1097with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
c906108c
SS
1098
1099@cindex abbreviation
1100@value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1101unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1102documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1103abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1104equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1105names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1106arguments to the @code{help} command.
1107
1108@cindex repeating commands
1109@kindex RET
1110A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
96a2c332 1111repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
c906108c
SS
1112will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1113repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1114repeat.
1115
1116The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1117@key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1118exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1119
1120@value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1121output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1122(@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen size}). Since it is easy to press one
1123@key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1124repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1125
1126@kindex #
1127@cindex comment
1128Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1129nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1130Files,,Command files}).
1131
53a5351d 1132@node Completion
c906108c
SS
1133@section Command completion
1134
1135@cindex completion
1136@cindex word completion
1137@value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1138only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1139are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1140commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1141
1142Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1143of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1144word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1145enter it). For example, if you type
1146
1147@c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1148@c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1149@c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1150@c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1151@example
1152(@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1153@end example
1154
1155@noindent
1156@value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1157the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1158
1159@example
1160(@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1161@end example
1162
1163@noindent
1164You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1165breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1166@samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1167were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1168might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1169to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1170
1171If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1172@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1173characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1174@value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1175example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1176begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1177just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1178function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1179example:
1180
1181@example
1182(@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1183@exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1184make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1185make_abs_section make_function_type
1186make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1187make_cleanup make_reference_type
1188make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1189(@value{GDBP}) b make_
1190@end example
1191
1192@noindent
1193After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1194partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1195command.
1196
1197If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1198can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
7a292a7a 1199means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
c906108c 1200key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
7a292a7a 1201one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
c906108c
SS
1202
1203@cindex quotes in commands
1204@cindex completion of quoted strings
1205Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
7a292a7a
SS
1206parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1207its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1208situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1209@value{GDBN} commands.
c906108c 1210
c906108c
SS
1211The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1212name of a C++ function. This is because C++ allows function overloading
1213(multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished by argument
1214type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you may need to
1215distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name} that takes an
1216@code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version that takes a
1217@code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the word-completion
1218facilities in this situation, type a single quote @code{'} at the
1219beginning of the function name. This alerts @value{GDBN} that it may need to
1220consider more information than usual when you press @key{TAB} or
1221@kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1222
1223@example
96a2c332 1224(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
c906108c
SS
1225bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1226(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1227@end example
1228
1229In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1230quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1231completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1232place:
1233
1234@example
1235(@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1236@exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1237(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1238@end example
1239
1240@noindent
1241In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1242you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1243completion on an overloaded symbol.
1244
d4f3574e 1245For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C plus plus
c906108c
SS
1246expressions, ,C++ expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1247overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
d4f3574e 1248see @ref{Debugging C plus plus, ,@value{GDBN} features for C++}.
c906108c
SS
1249
1250
53a5351d 1251@node Help
c906108c
SS
1252@section Getting help
1253@cindex online documentation
1254@kindex help
1255
1256You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1257using the command @code{help}.
1258
1259@table @code
1260@kindex h
1261@item help
1262@itemx h
1263You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1264display a short list of named classes of commands:
1265
1266@smallexample
1267(@value{GDBP}) help
1268List of classes of commands:
1269
2df3850c 1270aliases -- Aliases of other commands
c906108c 1271breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
2df3850c 1272data -- Examining data
c906108c 1273files -- Specifying and examining files
2df3850c
JM
1274internals -- Maintenance commands
1275obscure -- Obscure features
1276running -- Running the program
1277stack -- Examining the stack
c906108c
SS
1278status -- Status inquiries
1279support -- Support facilities
96a2c332
SS
1280tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without@*
1281 stopping the program
c906108c 1282user-defined -- User-defined commands
c906108c
SS
1283
1284Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1285commands in that class.
1286Type "help" followed by command name for full
1287documentation.
1288Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1289(@value{GDBP})
1290@end smallexample
96a2c332 1291@c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
c906108c
SS
1292
1293@item help @var{class}
1294Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1295list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1296help display for the class @code{status}:
1297
1298@smallexample
1299(@value{GDBP}) help status
1300Status inquiries.
1301
1302List of commands:
1303
1304@c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1305@c to fit in smallbook page size.
2df3850c
JM
1306info -- Generic command for showing things
1307 about the program being debugged
1308show -- Generic command for showing things
1309 about the debugger
c906108c
SS
1310
1311Type "help" followed by command name for full
1312documentation.
1313Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1314(@value{GDBP})
1315@end smallexample
1316
1317@item help @var{command}
1318With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1319short paragraph on how to use that command.
1320
6837a0a2
DB
1321@kindex apropos
1322@item apropos @var{args}
1323The @code{apropos @var{args}} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1324commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1325@var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1326
1327@smallexample
1328apropos reload
1329@end smallexample
1330
1331@noindent results in:
1332
1333@smallexample
1334@group
1335set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading multiple times in one run
1336show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading multiple times in one run
1337@end group
1338@end smallexample
1339
c906108c
SS
1340@kindex complete
1341@item complete @var{args}
1342The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1343for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1344command you want completed. For example:
1345
1346@smallexample
1347complete i
1348@end smallexample
1349
1350@noindent results in:
1351
1352@smallexample
1353@group
2df3850c
JM
1354if
1355ignore
c906108c
SS
1356info
1357inspect
c906108c
SS
1358@end group
1359@end smallexample
1360
1361@noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1362@end table
1363
1364In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1365and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1366of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1367manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1368under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1369all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1370
1371@c @group
1372@table @code
1373@kindex info
1374@kindex i
1375@item info
1376This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1377program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1378with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1379registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1380You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1381@w{@code{help info}}.
1382
1383@kindex set
1384@item set
1385You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1386@code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1387@code{set prompt $}.
1388
1389@kindex show
1390@item show
1391In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1392@value{GDBN} itself.
1393You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1394related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1395system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1396which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1397
1398@kindex info set
1399To display all the settable parameters and their current
1400values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1401@code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1402@c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1403@c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1404@c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1405@end table
1406@c @end group
1407
1408Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1409exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1410
1411@table @code
1412@kindex show version
1413@cindex version number
1414@item show version
1415Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
2df3850c
JM
1416information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1417@value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1418version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1419commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1420system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
96a2c332 1421variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
2df3850c
JM
1422The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1423@value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
1424
1425@kindex show copying
1426@item show copying
1427Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1428
1429@kindex show warranty
1430@item show warranty
2df3850c 1431Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
96a2c332 1432if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
2df3850c 1433
c906108c
SS
1434@end table
1435
53a5351d 1436@node Running
c906108c
SS
1437@chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1438
1439When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1440debugging information when you compile it.
7a292a7a
SS
1441
1442You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1443of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1444your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1445kill a child process.
c906108c
SS
1446
1447@menu
1448* Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1449* Starting:: Starting your program
c906108c
SS
1450* Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1451* Environment:: Your program's environment
c906108c
SS
1452
1453* Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1454* Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1455* Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1456* Kill Process:: Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1457
1458* Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1459* Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1460@end menu
1461
53a5351d 1462@node Compilation
c906108c
SS
1463@section Compiling for debugging
1464
1465In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1466debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1467is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1468variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1469and addresses in the executable code.
1470
1471To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1472the compiler.
1473
1474Many C compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O}
1475options together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1476executables containing debugging information.
1477
53a5351d
JM
1478@value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1479without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1480recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1481program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1482in pushing your luck.
c906108c
SS
1483
1484@cindex optimized code, debugging
1485@cindex debugging optimized code
1486When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1487optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1488really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1489exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1490variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1491variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1492
1493Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1494@samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1495doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1496please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1497
1498Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1499@w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1500format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1501
1502@need 2000
53a5351d 1503@node Starting
c906108c
SS
1504@section Starting your program
1505@cindex starting
1506@cindex running
1507
1508@table @code
1509@kindex run
1510@item run
1511@itemx r
7a292a7a
SS
1512Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1513You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1514argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1515@value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1516(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
c906108c
SS
1517
1518@end table
1519
c906108c
SS
1520If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1521supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1522that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1523@code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1524
1525The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1526receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1527information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1528can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1529your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1530divided into four categories:
1531
1532@table @asis
1533@item The @emph{arguments.}
1534Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1535@code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1536is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1537(such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1538the arguments.
1539In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1540@code{SHELL} environment variable.
1541@xref{Arguments, ,Your program's arguments}.
1542
1543@item The @emph{environment.}
1544Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1545use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1546environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1547your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}.
1548
1549@item The @emph{working directory.}
1550Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1551the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1552@xref{Working Directory, ,Your program's working directory}.
1553
1554@item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1555Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1556standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1557in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1558set a different device for your program.
1559@xref{Input/Output, ,Your program's input and output}.
1560
1561@cindex pipes
1562@emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1563pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1564program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1565wrong program.
1566@end table
c906108c
SS
1567
1568When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1569immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and continuing}, for discussion
1570of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1571stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1572or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1573
1574If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1575time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1576table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1577your current breakpoints.
1578
53a5351d 1579@node Arguments
c906108c
SS
1580@section Your program's arguments
1581
1582@cindex arguments (to your program)
1583The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
1584@code{run} command.
1585They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1586performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1587@code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1588@value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
d4f3574e
SS
1589the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1590
1591On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1592@value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1593calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1594the program, not by the shell.
c906108c
SS
1595
1596@code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1597@code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1598
1599@kindex set args
1600@table @code
1601@item set args
1602Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1603@code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1604with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1605using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1606it again without arguments.
1607
1608@kindex show args
1609@item show args
1610Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1611@end table
1612
53a5351d 1613@node Environment
c906108c
SS
1614@section Your program's environment
1615
1616@cindex environment (of your program)
1617The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1618their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1619your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1620path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1621the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1622debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1623environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1624
1625@table @code
1626@kindex path
1627@item path @var{directory}
1628Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
1629(the search path for executables), for both @value{GDBN} and your program.
d4f3574e
SS
1630You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1631system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1632MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1633is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
c906108c
SS
1634
1635You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1636working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1637use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1638@code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1639@var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1640@var{directory} to the search path.
1641@c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1642@c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1643
1644@kindex show paths
1645@item show paths
1646Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1647environment variable).
1648
1649@kindex show environment
1650@item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1651Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1652your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
1653print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1654your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1655
1656@kindex set environment
53a5351d 1657@item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
1658Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
1659changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
1660be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
1661any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
1662parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
1663null value.
1664@c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
1665@c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
1666
1667For example, this command:
1668
1669@example
1670set env USER = foo
1671@end example
1672
1673@noindent
d4f3574e 1674tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
c906108c
SS
1675@samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
1676are not actually required.)
1677
1678@kindex unset environment
1679@item unset environment @var{varname}
1680Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
1681program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
1682@code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
1683rather than assigning it an empty value.
1684@end table
1685
d4f3574e
SS
1686@emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
1687the shell indicated
c906108c
SS
1688by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
1689@code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
1690that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
1691@file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
1692your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
1693files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
1694@file{.profile}.
1695
53a5351d 1696@node Working Directory
c906108c
SS
1697@section Your program's working directory
1698
1699@cindex working directory (of your program)
1700Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
1701working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
1702The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
1703from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
1704working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
1705
1706The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
1707that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1708specify files}.
1709
1710@table @code
1711@kindex cd
1712@item cd @var{directory}
1713Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
1714
1715@kindex pwd
1716@item pwd
1717Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
1718@end table
1719
53a5351d 1720@node Input/Output
c906108c
SS
1721@section Your program's input and output
1722
1723@cindex redirection
1724@cindex i/o
1725@cindex terminal
1726By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
1727the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
1728to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
1729modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
1730running your program.
1731
1732@table @code
1733@kindex info terminal
1734@item info terminal
1735Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
1736program is using.
1737@end table
1738
1739You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
1740redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
1741
1742@example
1743run > outfile
1744@end example
1745
1746@noindent
1747starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
1748
1749@kindex tty
1750@cindex controlling terminal
1751Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
1752with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
1753argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
1754commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
1755process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
1756
1757@example
1758tty /dev/ttyb
1759@end example
1760
1761@noindent
1762directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
1763default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
1764that as their controlling terminal.
1765
1766An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
1767effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
1768terminal.
1769
1770When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
1771command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
1772for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal.
1773
53a5351d 1774@node Attach
c906108c
SS
1775@section Debugging an already-running process
1776@kindex attach
1777@cindex attach
1778
1779@table @code
1780@item attach @var{process-id}
1781This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
1782outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
1783targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
1784find out the process-id of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
1785or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
1786
1787@code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
1788executing the command.
1789@end table
1790
1791To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
1792which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
1793programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
1794also have permission to send the process a signal.
1795
1796When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
1797the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
1798the program is not found) by using the source file search path
1799(@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying source directories}). You can also use
1800the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1801Specify Files}.
1802
1803The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
1804process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
53a5351d
JM
1805with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
1806you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
1807can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
1808process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
c906108c
SS
1809attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
1810
1811@table @code
1812@kindex detach
1813@item detach
1814When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
1815@code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
1816the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
1817that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
1818are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
1819@code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
1820executing the command.
1821@end table
1822
1823If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
1824attached process, you kill that process. By default, @value{GDBN} asks
1825for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
1826control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
1827confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
1828messages}).
1829
53a5351d 1830@node Kill Process
c906108c 1831@section Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1832
1833@table @code
1834@kindex kill
1835@item kill
1836Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
1837@end table
1838
1839This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
1840running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
1841is running.
1842
1843On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
1844while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
1845@code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
1846outside the debugger.
1847
1848The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
1849relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
1850executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
1851next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
1852reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
1853breakpoint settings).
1854
53a5351d 1855@node Threads
c906108c 1856@section Debugging programs with multiple threads
c906108c
SS
1857
1858@cindex threads of execution
1859@cindex multiple threads
1860@cindex switching threads
1861In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
1862may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
1863of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
1864the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
1865that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
1866modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
1867registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
1868
1869@value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
1870programs:
1871
1872@itemize @bullet
1873@item automatic notification of new threads
1874@item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
1875@item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
1876@item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
1877a command to apply a command to a list of threads
1878@item thread-specific breakpoints
1879@end itemize
1880
c906108c
SS
1881@quotation
1882@emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
1883@value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
1884If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
1885effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
1886from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
1887like this:
1888
1889@smallexample
1890(@value{GDBP}) info threads
1891(@value{GDBP}) thread 1
1892Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
1893see the IDs of currently known threads.
1894@end smallexample
1895@c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
1896@c doesn't support threads"?
1897@end quotation
c906108c
SS
1898
1899@cindex focus of debugging
1900@cindex current thread
1901The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
1902threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
1903control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
1904This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
1905program information from the perspective of the current thread.
1906
c906108c
SS
1907@kindex New @var{systag}
1908@cindex thread identifier (system)
1909@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
1910@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
1911@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
1912Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
1913the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
1914form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
1915whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
1916LynxOS, you might see
1917
1918@example
1919[New process 35 thread 27]
1920@end example
1921
1922@noindent
1923when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
1924the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
1925further qualifier.
1926
1927@c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
1928@c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
1929@c second---i.e., when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
1930@c program?
1931@c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
1932@c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
1933@c threads ab initio?
1934
1935@cindex thread number
1936@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
1937For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
1938number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
1939
1940@table @code
1941@kindex info threads
1942@item info threads
1943Display a summary of all threads currently in your
1944program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
1945
1946@enumerate
1947@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
1948
1949@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
1950
1951@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
1952@end enumerate
1953
1954@noindent
1955An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
1956indicates the current thread.
1957
1958For example,
1959@end table
1960@c end table here to get a little more width for example
1961
1962@smallexample
1963(@value{GDBP}) info threads
1964 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
1965 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
1966* 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
1967 at threadtest.c:68
1968@end smallexample
53a5351d
JM
1969
1970On HP-UX systems:
c906108c
SS
1971
1972@cindex thread number
1973@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
1974For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
1975number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
1976thread in your program.
1977
1978@kindex New @var{systag}
1979@cindex thread identifier (system)
1980@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
1981@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
1982@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
1983Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
1984both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
1985form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
1986whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
1987HP-UX, you see
1988
1989@example
1990[New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
1991@end example
1992
1993@noindent
1994when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
1995
1996@table @code
1997@kindex info threads
1998@item info threads
1999Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2000program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2001
2002@enumerate
2003@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2004
2005@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2006
2007@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2008@end enumerate
2009
2010@noindent
2011An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2012indicates the current thread.
2013
2014For example,
2015@end table
2016@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2017
2018@example
2019(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2020 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") at quicksort.c:137
2021 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () from /usr/lib/libc.2
2022 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () from /usr/lib/libc.2
2023@end example
c906108c
SS
2024
2025@table @code
2026@kindex thread @var{threadno}
2027@item thread @var{threadno}
2028Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2029argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2030shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2031@value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2032you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2033
2034@smallexample
2035@c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2036(@value{GDBP}) thread 2
c906108c 2037[Switching to process 35 thread 23]
c906108c
SS
20380x34e5 in sigpause ()
2039@end smallexample
2040
2041@noindent
2042As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2043@samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2044threads.
2045
2046@kindex thread apply
2047@item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}
2048The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply a command to one or
2049more threads. Specify the numbers of the threads that you want affected
2050with the command argument @var{threadno}. @var{threadno} is the internal
2051@value{GDBN} thread number, as shown in the first field of the @samp{info
2052threads} display. To apply a command to all threads, use
2053@code{thread apply all} @var{args}.
2054@end table
2055
2056@cindex automatic thread selection
2057@cindex switching threads automatically
2058@cindex threads, automatic switching
2059Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2060signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2061signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2062message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2063thread.
2064
2065@xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and starting multi-thread programs}, for
2066more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2067programs with multiple threads.
2068
2069@xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting watchpoints}, for information about
2070watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
c906108c 2071
53a5351d 2072@node Processes
c906108c
SS
2073@section Debugging programs with multiple processes
2074
2075@cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2076@cindex multiple processes
2077@cindex processes, multiple
53a5351d
JM
2078On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2079programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2080function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2081parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2082set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2083will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2084will cause it to terminate.
c906108c
SS
2085
2086However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2087which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2088the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2089only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2090so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2091on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2092get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2093@value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
d4f3574e 2094the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
c906108c 2095the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
c906108c 2096
53a5351d
JM
2097On HP-UX (11.x and later only?), @value{GDBN} provides support for
2098debugging programs that create additional processes using the
2099@code{fork} or @code{vfork} function.
c906108c
SS
2100
2101By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2102the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2103
2104If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2105use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2106
2107@table @code
2108@kindex set follow-fork-mode
2109@item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2110Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2111@code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2112process. The @var{mode} can be:
2113
2114@table @code
2115@item parent
2116The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2df3850c 2117unimpeded. This is the default.
c906108c
SS
2118
2119@item child
2120The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2121unimpeded.
2122
2123@item ask
2124The debugger will ask for one of the above choices.
2125@end table
2126
2127@item show follow-fork-mode
2df3850c 2128Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
c906108c
SS
2129@end table
2130
2131If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2132@code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2133breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2134@code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2135the child process's @code{main}.
2136
2137When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2138child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2139
2140If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2141call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2142use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2143argument.
2144
2145You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2146a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2147Catchpoints, ,Setting catchpoints}.
c906108c 2148
53a5351d 2149@node Stopping
c906108c
SS
2150@chapter Stopping and Continuing
2151
2152The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2153program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2154trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2155
7a292a7a
SS
2156Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2157such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2158@value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2159change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2160continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2161ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2162explicitly request this information at any time.
c906108c
SS
2163
2164@table @code
2165@kindex info program
2166@item info program
2167Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
7a292a7a 2168running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
c906108c
SS
2169@end table
2170
2171@menu
2172* Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2173* Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
c906108c 2174* Signals:: Signals
c906108c 2175* Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
c906108c
SS
2176@end menu
2177
53a5351d 2178@node Breakpoints
c906108c
SS
2179@section Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2180
2181@cindex breakpoints
2182A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2183the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2184control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2185breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2186Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2187should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2188program.
2189
2190In HP-UX, SunOS 4.x, SVR4, and Alpha OSF/1 configurations, you can set
2191breakpoints in shared libraries before the executable is run. There is
2192a minor limitation on HP-UX systems: you must wait until the executable
2193is run in order to set breakpoints in shared library routines that are
2194not called directly by the program (for example, routines that are
2195arguments in a @code{pthread_create} call).
2196
2197@cindex watchpoints
2198@cindex memory tracing
2199@cindex breakpoint on memory address
2200@cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2201A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2202when the value of an expression changes. You must use a different
2203command to set watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting
2204watchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a watchpoint like
2205any other breakpoint: you enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints
2206and watchpoints using the same commands.
2207
2208You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2209whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2210Automatic display}.
2211
2212@cindex catchpoints
2213@cindex breakpoint on events
2214A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2215when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C++
2216exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2217different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2218catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2219other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
d4f3574e 2220@code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
2221
2222@cindex breakpoint numbers
2223@cindex numbers for breakpoints
2224@value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2225catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2226starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2227features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2228breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2229@dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2230enable it again.
2231
c5394b80
JM
2232@cindex breakpoint ranges
2233@cindex ranges of breakpoints
2234Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2235operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2236@samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2237hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2238all breakpoint in that range are operated on.
2239
c906108c
SS
2240@menu
2241* Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2242* Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2243* Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2244* Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2245* Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2246* Conditions:: Break conditions
2247* Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
c906108c 2248* Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
d4f3574e 2249* Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
2250@end menu
2251
53a5351d 2252@node Set Breaks
c906108c
SS
2253@subsection Setting breakpoints
2254
2255@c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
2256@c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2257@c
2258@c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2259
2260@kindex break
2261@kindex b
2262@kindex $bpnum
2263@cindex latest breakpoint
2264Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
2265@code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
2266number of the breakpoints you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
2267Vars,, Convenience variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2268convenience variables.
2269
2270You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2271
2272@table @code
2273@item break @var{function}
2274Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
c906108c
SS
2275When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
2276C++, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
2277@xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
c906108c
SS
2278
2279@item break +@var{offset}
2280@itemx break -@var{offset}
2281Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
d4f3574e 2282at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2df3850c 2283(@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
c906108c
SS
2284
2285@item break @var{linenum}
2286Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
d4f3574e
SS
2287The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2288The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
c906108c
SS
2289code on that line.
2290
2291@item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2292Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2293
2294@item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2295Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2296@var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2297superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2298functions.
2299
2300@item break *@var{address}
2301Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2302breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2303information or source files.
2304
2305@item break
2306When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2307the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2308(@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2309innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2310returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2311@code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2312that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2313@code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2314the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2315inside loops.
2316
2317@value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2318least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2319would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2320breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2321existed when your program stopped.
2322
2323@item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2324Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2325@var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2326value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2327@samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2328above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2329,Break conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2330
2331@kindex tbreak
2332@item tbreak @var{args}
2333Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2334same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2335way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2336program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2337
c906108c
SS
2338@kindex hbreak
2339@item hbreak @var{args}
d4f3574e
SS
2340Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2341@code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
c906108c
SS
2342breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2343have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
d4f3574e
SS
2344debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2345changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2346provided by SPARClite DSU and some x86-based targets. These targets
2347will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2348address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2349breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2350example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2351@value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2352or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2353(@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling}). @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2354
2355@kindex thbreak
2356@item thbreak @var{args}
2357Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2358are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
2359the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
2360the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2361first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
2362command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2363may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
d4f3574e 2364See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2365
2366@kindex rbreak
2367@cindex regular expression
2368@item rbreak @var{regex}
c906108c 2369Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
11cf8741
JM
2370@var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2371matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2372breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2373the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2374them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2375
2376The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2377like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2378shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2379an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2380@code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2381match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
c906108c 2382
c906108c
SS
2383When debugging C++ programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
2384breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2385classes.
c906108c
SS
2386
2387@kindex info breakpoints
2388@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2389@item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2390@itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2391@itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2392Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2393not deleted, with the following columns for each breakpoint:
2394
2395@table @emph
2396@item Breakpoint Numbers
2397@item Type
2398Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2399@item Disposition
2400Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2401@item Enabled or Disabled
2402Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2403that are not enabled.
2404@item Address
2df3850c 2405Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address.
c906108c
SS
2406@item What
2407Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
2408line number.
2409@end table
2410
2411@noindent
2412If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
2413the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
2414are listed after that.
2415
2416@noindent
2417@code{info break} with a breakpoint
2418number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
2419convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
2420the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
2421listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).
2422
2423@noindent
2424@code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
2425has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
2426@code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
2427hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
2428was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
2429will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
2430@end table
2431
2432@value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
2433your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
2434the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
2435(@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
2436
2437@cindex negative breakpoint numbers
2438@cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
2439@value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for special
2440purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C programs).
2441These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers, starting with
2442@code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
2443
2444You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
2445@samp{maint info breakpoints}.
2446
2447@table @code
2448@kindex maint info breakpoints
2449@item maint info breakpoints
2450Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
2451breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
2452internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
2453breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
2454is shown:
2455
2456@table @code
2457@item breakpoint
2458Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
2459
2460@item watchpoint
2461Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
2462
2463@item longjmp
2464Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
2465@code{longjmp} calls.
2466
2467@item longjmp resume
2468Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
2469
2470@item until
2471Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
2472
2473@item finish
2474Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
2475
c906108c
SS
2476@item shlib events
2477Shared library events.
53a5351d 2478
c906108c 2479@end table
53a5351d 2480
c906108c
SS
2481@end table
2482
2483
53a5351d 2484@node Set Watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2485@subsection Setting watchpoints
2486
2487@cindex setting watchpoints
2488@cindex software watchpoints
2489@cindex hardware watchpoints
2490You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
2491expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
2492this may happen.
2493
2494Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
2df3850c 2495hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
c906108c
SS
2496program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
2497times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
2498catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
2499culprit.)
2500
d4f3574e 2501On some systems, such as HP-UX, Linux and some other x86-based targets,
2df3850c 2502@value{GDBN} includes support for
c906108c
SS
2503hardware watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your
2504program.
2505
2506@table @code
2507@kindex watch
2508@item watch @var{expr}
2509Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when @var{expr}
2510is written into by the program and its value changes.
2511
2512@kindex rwatch
2513@item rwatch @var{expr}
2514Set a watchpoint that will break when watch @var{expr} is read by the program.
c906108c
SS
2515
2516@kindex awatch
2517@item awatch @var{expr}
2df3850c 2518Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read or written into
7be570e7 2519by the program.
c906108c
SS
2520
2521@kindex info watchpoints
2522@item info watchpoints
2523This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
2524it is the same as @code{info break}.
2525@end table
2526
2527@value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
2528watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
2529value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
2530cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
2531executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
2532statement, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
2533
2534When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
2535
2536@example
2537Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
2538@end example
2539
2540@noindent
2541if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
2542
7be570e7
JM
2543Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
2544hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
2545value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
2546every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
2547that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
2548hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
2549will print a message like this:
2550
2551@smallexample
2552Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
2553@end smallexample
2554
2555Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
2556data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
2557watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
2558can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
2559cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
2560double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
2561wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
2562into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
2563
2564If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
2565to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
2566Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
2567time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
2568able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
2569warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
2570
2571@smallexample
2572Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
2573@end smallexample
2574
2575@noindent
2576If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
2577
2578The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
2579or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
2580data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
2581hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
2582both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
2583watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
2584@strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
2585watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
c906108c
SS
2586@value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
2587Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
2588
2589If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
2df3850c 2590any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
c906108c
SS
2591kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
2592
7be570e7
JM
2593@value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
2594(automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
2595they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
2596which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
2597being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
2598and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
2599rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
2600way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
2601@code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
2602
c906108c
SS
2603@quotation
2604@cindex watchpoints and threads
2605@cindex threads and watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2606@emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
2607usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
2608can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
2609you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
2610thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
2611can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
2612@value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
2613the expression.
53a5351d 2614
d4f3574e 2615@c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
53a5351d
JM
2616@emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
2617have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
2618watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
2619single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
2620change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
2621confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
2622software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
2623when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
2624watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
c906108c 2625@end quotation
c906108c 2626
53a5351d 2627@node Set Catchpoints
c906108c 2628@subsection Setting catchpoints
d4f3574e 2629@cindex catchpoints, setting
c906108c
SS
2630@cindex exception handlers
2631@cindex event handling
2632
2633You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
2634kinds of program events, such as C++ exceptions or the loading of a
2635shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
2636
2637@table @code
2638@kindex catch
2639@item catch @var{event}
2640Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
2641@table @code
2642@item throw
2643@kindex catch throw
2644The throwing of a C++ exception.
2645
2646@item catch
2647@kindex catch catch
2648The catching of a C++ exception.
2649
2650@item exec
2651@kindex catch exec
2652A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2653
2654@item fork
2655@kindex catch fork
2656A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2657
2658@item vfork
2659@kindex catch vfork
2660A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2661
2662@item load
2663@itemx load @var{libname}
2664@kindex catch load
2665The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
2666@var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2667
2668@item unload
2669@itemx unload @var{libname}
2670@kindex catch unload
2671The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
2672of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2673@end table
2674
2675@item tcatch @var{event}
2676Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
2677automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
2678
2679@end table
2680
2681Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
2682
2683There are currently some limitations to C++ exception handling
2684(@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
2685
2686@itemize @bullet
2687@item
2688If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
2689control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
2690raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
2691returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
2692simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
2693that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
2694you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
2695disabled within interactive calls.
2696
2697@item
2698You cannot raise an exception interactively.
2699
2700@item
2701You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
2702@end itemize
2703
2704@cindex raise exceptions
2705Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
2706if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
2707stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
2708can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
2709breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
2710out where the exception was raised.
2711
2712To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
2713knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C++, exceptions are
2714raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
2715which has the following ANSI C interface:
2716
2717@example
2718 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
d4f3574e
SS
2719 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
2720 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
c906108c
SS
2721@end example
2722
2723@noindent
2724To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
2725unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
2726(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and exceptions}).
2727
2728With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions})
2729that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
2730a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
2731breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
2732raised.
2733
2734
53a5351d 2735@node Delete Breaks
c906108c
SS
2736@subsection Deleting breakpoints
2737
2738@cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2739@cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2740It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2741catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
2742to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
2743breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
2744
2745With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
2746where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
2747delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
2748their breakpoint numbers.
2749
2750It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
2751automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
2752when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
2753
2754@table @code
2755@kindex clear
2756@item clear
2757Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
2758selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). When
2759the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
2760breakpoint where your program just stopped.
2761
2762@item clear @var{function}
2763@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
2764Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the function @var{function}.
2765
2766@item clear @var{linenum}
2767@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2768Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified line.
2769
2770@cindex delete breakpoints
2771@kindex delete
2772@kindex d
c5394b80
JM
2773@item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2774Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
2775ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
c906108c
SS
2776breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
2777confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
2778@end table
2779
53a5351d 2780@node Disabling
c906108c
SS
2781@subsection Disabling breakpoints
2782
2783@kindex disable breakpoints
2784@kindex enable breakpoints
2785Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
2786prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
2787it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
2788that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
2789
2790You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
2791the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
2792or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
2793@code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
2794catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
2795
2796A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
2797states of enablement:
2798
2799@itemize @bullet
2800@item
2801Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
2802with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
2803@item
2804Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
2805@item
2806Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
d4f3574e 2807disabled.
c906108c
SS
2808@item
2809Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
d4f3574e
SS
2810immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
2811set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
c906108c
SS
2812@end itemize
2813
2814You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
2815watchpoints, and catchpoints:
2816
2817@table @code
2818@kindex disable breakpoints
2819@kindex disable
2820@kindex dis
c5394b80 2821@item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
2822Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
2823listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
2824options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
2825case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
2826@code{disable} as @code{dis}.
2827
2828@kindex enable breakpoints
2829@kindex enable
c5394b80 2830@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
2831Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
2832become effective once again in stopping your program.
2833
c5394b80 2834@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
c906108c
SS
2835Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
2836of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
2837
c5394b80 2838@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
c906108c
SS
2839Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
2840deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
2841@end table
2842
d4f3574e
SS
2843@c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
2844@c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
c906108c
SS
2845Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
2846,Setting breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
2847subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
2848the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
2849breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
2850breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
2851stepping}.)
2852
53a5351d 2853@node Conditions
c906108c
SS
2854@subsection Break conditions
2855@cindex conditional breakpoints
2856@cindex breakpoint conditions
2857
2858@c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
2859@c in particular for a watchpoint?
2860The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
2861specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
2862breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
2863programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
2864a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
2865and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
2866
2867This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
2868situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
2869when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
2870by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
2871@samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
2872
2873Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
2874since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
2875it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
2876and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
2877one.
2878
2879Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
2880your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
2881that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
2882format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
2883unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
2884that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
2885program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
d4f3574e
SS
2886breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
2887conditions for the
c906108c
SS
2888purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
2889(@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint command lists}).
2890
2891Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
2892@samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
2893Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
2894with the @code{condition} command.
53a5351d 2895
c906108c
SS
2896You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
2897The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
2898@code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
2899catchpoint.
c906108c
SS
2900
2901@table @code
2902@kindex condition
2903@item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
2904Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
2905watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
2906breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
2907@var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
2908@code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
2909syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
d4f3574e
SS
2910referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
2911symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
2912prints an error message:
2913
2914@example
2915No symbol "foo" in current context.
2916@end example
2917
2918@noindent
c906108c
SS
2919@value{GDBN} does
2920not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
d4f3574e
SS
2921command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
2922@code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
c906108c
SS
2923
2924@item condition @var{bnum}
2925Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
2926an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
2927@end table
2928
2929@cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
2930A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
2931breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
2932useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
2933count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
2934is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
2935therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
2936ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
2937the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
2938value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
2939your program reaches it.
2940
2941@table @code
2942@kindex ignore
2943@item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
2944Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
2945The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
2946execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
2947takes no action.
2948
2949To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
2950a count of zero.
2951
2952When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
2953breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
2954@code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
2955Stepping,,Continuing and stepping}.
2956
2957If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
2958condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
2959@value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
2960
2961You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
2962as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
2963is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
2964variables}.
2965@end table
2966
2967Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
2968
2969
53a5351d 2970@node Break Commands
c906108c
SS
2971@subsection Breakpoint command lists
2972
2973@cindex breakpoint commands
2974You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
2975commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
2976example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
2977enable other breakpoints.
2978
2979@table @code
2980@kindex commands
2981@kindex end
2982@item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
2983@itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
2984@itemx end
2985Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
2986themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
2987@code{end} to terminate the commands.
2988
2989To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
2990follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
2991
2992With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
2993breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
2994recently encountered).
2995@end table
2996
2997Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
2998disabled within a @var{command-list}.
2999
3000You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3001use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3002that resumes execution.
3003
3004Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3005execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3006(even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3007another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3008ambiguities about which list to execute.
3009
3010@kindex silent
3011If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3012usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3013be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3014then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3015see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3016meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3017
3018The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3019print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3020breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for controlled output}.
3021
3022For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3023value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3024
3025@example
3026break foo if x>0
3027commands
3028silent
3029printf "x is %d\n",x
3030cont
3031end
3032@end example
3033
3034One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3035you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3036of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3037erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3038to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3039so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3040command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3041
3042@example
3043break 403
3044commands
3045silent
3046set x = y + 4
3047cont
3048end
3049@end example
3050
53a5351d 3051@node Breakpoint Menus
c906108c
SS
3052@subsection Breakpoint menus
3053@cindex overloading
3054@cindex symbol overloading
3055
3056Some programming languages (notably C++) permit a single function name
3057to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3058This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3059@samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3060a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
3061something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
3062particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3063you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3064waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3065options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3066sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3067@kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3068breakpoints.
3069
3070For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3071breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3072We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3073
3074@c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3075@smallexample
3076@group
3077(@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3078[0] cancel
3079[1] all
3080[2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3081[3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3082[4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3083[5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3084[6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3085[7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3086> 2 4 6
3087Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3088Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3089Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3090Multiple breakpoints were set.
3091Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3092 breakpoints.
3093(@value{GDBP})
3094@end group
3095@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
3096
3097@c @ifclear BARETARGET
d4f3574e
SS
3098@node Error in Breakpoints
3099@subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
3100@c
3101@c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3102@c
d4f3574e
SS
3103Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3104any other process is running that program. In this situation,
3105attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
3106@value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3107
3108@example
3109Cannot insert breakpoints.
3110The same program may be running in another process.
3111@end example
3112
3113When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3114
3115@enumerate
3116@item
3117Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3118
3119@item
3120Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
3121name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
3122that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
3123Then start your program again.
3124
3125@item
3126Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3127linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3128to nonsharable executables.
3129@end enumerate
c906108c
SS
3130@c @end ifclear
3131
d4f3574e
SS
3132A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3133hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3134
3135@c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3136@c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3137@smallexample
3138Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3139You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3140@end smallexample
3141
3142@noindent
3143This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3144only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3145watchpoints it needs to insert.
3146
3147When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3148hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3149
3150
53a5351d 3151@node Continuing and Stepping
c906108c
SS
3152@section Continuing and stepping
3153
3154@cindex stepping
3155@cindex continuing
3156@cindex resuming execution
3157@dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3158completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3159one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3160line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
7a292a7a
SS
3161particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3162your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
d4f3574e
SS
3163it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3164@samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
3165
3166@table @code
3167@kindex continue
3168@kindex c
3169@kindex fg
3170@item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3171@itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3172@itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3173Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3174any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3175@var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3176ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3177@code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3178
3179The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3180stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3181@code{continue} is ignored.
3182
d4f3574e
SS
3183The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3184debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3185purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3186@code{continue}.
c906108c
SS
3187@end table
3188
3189To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3190(@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}) to go back to the
3191calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3192different address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3193
3194A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3195(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and catchpoints}) at the
3196beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3197is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3198and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3199interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3200
3201@table @code
3202@kindex step
3203@kindex s
3204@item step
3205Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3206line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3207abbreviated @code{s}.
3208
3209@quotation
3210@c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3211@c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3212@c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3213@c distinction here.
3214@emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3215within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3216execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3217debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3218is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3219without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3220below.
3221@end quotation
3222
d4f3574e
SS
3223The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3224source line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
c906108c
SS
3225switch statements, for loops, etc. @code{step} continues to stop if a
3226function that has debugging information is called within the line.
d4f3574e
SS
3227In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions called
3228within the line.
c906108c 3229
d4f3574e
SS
3230Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
3231number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
c906108c
SS
3232@code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
3233on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
3234was any debugging information about the routine.
3235
3236@item step @var{count}
3237Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
7a292a7a
SS
3238breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3239@var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
c906108c
SS
3240
3241@kindex next
3242@kindex n
3243@item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
3244Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
7a292a7a
SS
3245This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
3246the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
3247control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
3248that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
3249is abbreviated @code{n}.
c906108c
SS
3250
3251An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
3252
3253
3254@c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
3255@c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
3256@c
3257@c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
3258@c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
3259@c function are executed without stopping.
3260
d4f3574e
SS
3261The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3262source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
c906108c
SS
3263switch statements, for loops, etc.
3264
3265@kindex finish
3266@item finish
3267Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
3268returns. Print the returned value (if any).
3269
3270Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
3271,Returning from a function}).
3272
3273@kindex until
3274@kindex u
3275@item until
3276@itemx u
3277Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
3278current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
3279stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
3280command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
3281automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
3282than the address of the jump.
3283
3284This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
3285though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
3286exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
3287simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
3288through the next iteration.
3289
3290@code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
3291stack frame.
3292
3293@code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
3294of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
3295example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
3296(@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
3297@code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
3298
3299@example
3300(@value{GDBP}) f
3301#0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
3302206 expand_input();
3303(@value{GDBP}) until
3304195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
3305@end example
3306
3307This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
3308generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
3309start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
3310written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
3311to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
3312expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
3313statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
3314
3315@code{until} with no argument works by means of single
3316instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
3317argument.
3318
3319@item until @var{location}
3320@itemx u @var{location}
3321Continue running your program until either the specified location is
3322reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
3323the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3324,Setting breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints,
3325and hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument.
3326
3327@kindex stepi
3328@kindex si
3329@item stepi
96a2c332 3330@itemx stepi @var{arg}
c906108c
SS
3331@itemx si
3332Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
3333
3334It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
3335instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
3336instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
3337Display,, Automatic display}.
3338
3339An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
3340
3341@need 750
3342@kindex nexti
3343@kindex ni
3344@item nexti
96a2c332 3345@itemx nexti @var{arg}
c906108c
SS
3346@itemx ni
3347Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
3348proceed until the function returns.
3349
3350An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
3351@end table
3352
53a5351d 3353@node Signals
c906108c
SS
3354@section Signals
3355@cindex signals
3356
3357A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
3358operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
3359kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
d4f3574e 3360signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{C-c});
c906108c
SS
3361@code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
3362memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
3363the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
3364requested an alarm).
3365
3366@cindex fatal signals
3367Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
3368functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
d4f3574e 3369errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
c906108c
SS
3370program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
3371@code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
3372fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
3373
3374@value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
3375program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
3376signal.
3377
3378@cindex handling signals
3379Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to ignore non-erroneous signals like @code{SIGALRM}
3380(so as not to interfere with their role in the functioning of your program)
3381but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
3382You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
3383
3384@table @code
3385@kindex info signals
3386@item info signals
96a2c332 3387@itemx info handle
c906108c
SS
3388Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
3389handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
3390the defined types of signals.
3391
d4f3574e 3392@code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
c906108c
SS
3393
3394@kindex handle
3395@item handle @var{signal} @var{keywords}@dots{}
3396Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can
3397be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the @samp{SIG} at the
3398beginning). The @var{keywords} say what change to make.
3399@end table
3400
3401@c @group
3402The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
3403Their full names are:
3404
3405@table @code
3406@item nostop
3407@value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
3408still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
3409
3410@item stop
3411@value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
3412the @code{print} keyword as well.
3413
3414@item print
3415@value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
3416
3417@item noprint
3418@value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
3419implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
3420
3421@item pass
3422@value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
3423can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
3424and not handled.
3425
3426@item nopass
3427@value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
3428@end table
3429@c @end group
3430
d4f3574e
SS
3431When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
3432program until you
c906108c
SS
3433continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
3434effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
3435after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
3436command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
3437program sees that signal when you continue.
3438
3439You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
3440seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
3441or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
3442due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
3443values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
3444execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
3445a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
3446you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
3447program a signal}.
c906108c 3448
53a5351d 3449@node Thread Stops
c906108c
SS
3450@section Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3451
3452When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
3453programs with multiple threads}), you can choose whether to set
3454breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
3455
3456@table @code
3457@cindex breakpoints and threads
3458@cindex thread breakpoints
3459@kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
3460@item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
3461@itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
3462@var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
3463writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
3464
3465Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
3466to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
3467particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
3468numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
3469column of the @samp{info threads} display.
3470
3471If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
3472breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
3473program.
3474
3475You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
3476well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
3477breakpoint condition, like this:
3478
3479@smallexample
2df3850c 3480(@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
c906108c
SS
3481@end smallexample
3482
3483@end table
3484
3485@cindex stopped threads
3486@cindex threads, stopped
3487Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
3488@emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
3489allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
3490switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
3491underfoot.
3492
3493@cindex continuing threads
3494@cindex threads, continuing
3495Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
3496executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
3497like @code{step} or @code{next}.
3498
3499In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
3500Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
3501system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
3502execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
3503single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
3504statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
3505stops.
3506
3507You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
3508continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
3509thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
3510first thread completes whatever you requested.
3511
3512On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
3513thread to run.
3514
3515@table @code
3516@item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
3517Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
3518locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
3519current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
3520mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
3521``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
3522stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
d4f3574e 3523when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
c906108c 3524function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
d4f3574e 3525like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
c906108c 3526thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
2df3850c 3527@value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
c906108c
SS
3528
3529@item show scheduler-locking
3530Display the current scheduler locking mode.
3531@end table
3532
c906108c 3533
53a5351d 3534@node Stack
c906108c
SS
3535@chapter Examining the Stack
3536
3537When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
3538stopped and how it got there.
3539
3540@cindex call stack
3541Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
3542is generated.
3543That information includes the location of the call in your program,
3544the arguments of the call,
3545and the local variables of the function being called.
3546The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
3547The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
3548stack}.
3549
3550When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
3551stack allow you to see all of this information.
3552
3553@cindex selected frame
3554One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
3555@value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
3556particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
3557your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
3558special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
3559interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3560
3561When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
3562currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
3563@code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}).
3564
3565@menu
3566* Frames:: Stack frames
3567* Backtrace:: Backtraces
3568* Selection:: Selecting a frame
3569* Frame Info:: Information on a frame
c906108c
SS
3570
3571@end menu
3572
53a5351d 3573@node Frames
c906108c
SS
3574@section Stack frames
3575
d4f3574e 3576@cindex frame, definition
c906108c
SS
3577@cindex stack frame
3578The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
3579frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
3580with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
3581to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
3582which the function is executing.
3583
3584@cindex initial frame
3585@cindex outermost frame
3586@cindex innermost frame
3587When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
3588function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
3589@dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
3590made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
3591is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
3592the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
3593actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
3594recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
3595
3596@cindex frame pointer
3597Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
3598stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
3599kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
3600address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
3601in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register} while execution is
3602going on in that frame.
3603
3604@cindex frame number
3605@value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
3606zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
3607and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
3608they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
3609frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
3610
3611@c below produces an acceptable overful hbox. --mew 13aug1993
3612@cindex frameless execution
3613Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
3614without stack frames. (For example, the @code{@value{GCC}} option
3615@samp{-fomit-frame-pointer} generates functions without a frame.)
3616This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
3617the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
3618with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
3619has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
3620it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
3621correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
3622no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
3623
3624@table @code
d4f3574e 3625@kindex frame@r{, command}
c906108c
SS
3626@item frame @var{args}
3627The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
3628and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
3629address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
3630@code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
3631
3632@kindex select-frame
3633@item select-frame
3634The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
3635to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
3636@code{frame}.
3637@end table
3638
53a5351d 3639@node Backtrace
c906108c
SS
3640@section Backtraces
3641
3642@cindex backtraces
3643@cindex tracebacks
3644@cindex stack traces
3645A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
3646line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
3647frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
3648stack.
3649
3650@table @code
3651@kindex backtrace
3652@kindex bt
3653@item backtrace
3654@itemx bt
3655Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
3656frames in the stack.
3657
3658You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
3659character, normally @kbd{C-c}.
3660
3661@item backtrace @var{n}
3662@itemx bt @var{n}
3663Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
3664
3665@item backtrace -@var{n}
3666@itemx bt -@var{n}
3667Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
3668@end table
3669
3670@kindex where
3671@kindex info stack
3672@kindex info s
3673The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
3674are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
3675
3676Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
3677The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
3678print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
3679line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
3680counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
3681line number.
3682
3683Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
3684@samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
3685
3686@smallexample
3687@group
3688#0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
3689 at builtin.c:993
3690#1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
3691#2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
3692 at macro.c:71
3693(More stack frames follow...)
3694@end group
3695@end smallexample
3696
3697@noindent
3698The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
3699value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
3700code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
3701
53a5351d 3702@node Selection
c906108c
SS
3703@section Selecting a frame
3704
3705Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
3706whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
3707selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
3708of the stack frame just selected.
3709
3710@table @code
d4f3574e 3711@kindex frame@r{, selecting}
c906108c
SS
3712@kindex f
3713@item frame @var{n}
3714@itemx f @var{n}
3715Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
3716(currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
3717innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
3718@code{main}.
3719
3720@item frame @var{addr}
3721@itemx f @var{addr}
3722Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
3723chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
3724impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
3725addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
3726switches between them.
3727
c906108c
SS
3728On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
3729select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
3730
3731On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
3732pointer and a program counter.
3733
3734On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
3735pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
3736@c note to future updaters: this is conditioned on a flag
3737@c SETUP_ARBITRARY_FRAME in the tm-*.h files. The above is up to date
3738@c as of 27 Jan 1994.
c906108c
SS
3739
3740@kindex up
3741@item up @var{n}
3742Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3743advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
3744that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
3745
3746@kindex down
3747@kindex do
3748@item down @var{n}
3749Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3750advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
3751that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
3752abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
3753@end table
3754
3755All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
3756frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
3757arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
3758frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
3759
3760@need 1000
3761For example:
3762
3763@smallexample
3764@group
3765(@value{GDBP}) up
3766#1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
3767 at env.c:10
376810 read_input_file (argv[i]);
3769@end group
3770@end smallexample
3771
3772After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
3773prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
3774@xref{List, ,Printing source lines}.
3775
3776@table @code
3777@kindex down-silently
3778@kindex up-silently
3779@item up-silently @var{n}
3780@itemx down-silently @var{n}
3781These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
3782respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
3783causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
3784in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
3785distracting.
3786@end table
3787
53a5351d 3788@node Frame Info
c906108c
SS
3789@section Information about a frame
3790
3791There are several other commands to print information about the selected
3792stack frame.
3793
3794@table @code
3795@item frame
3796@itemx f
3797When used without any argument, this command does not change which
3798frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
3799selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
3800argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
3801@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3802
3803@kindex info frame
3804@kindex info f
3805@item info frame
3806@itemx info f
3807This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
3808including:
3809
3810@itemize @bullet
3811@item
3812the address of the frame
3813@item
3814the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
3815@item
3816the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
3817@item
3818the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
3819@item
3820the address of the frame's arguments
3821@item
d4f3574e
SS
3822the address of the frame's local variables
3823@item
c906108c
SS
3824the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
3825@item
3826which registers were saved in the frame
3827@end itemize
3828
3829@noindent The verbose description is useful when
3830something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
3831the usual conventions.
3832
3833@item info frame @var{addr}
3834@itemx info f @var{addr}
3835Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
3836selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
3837command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
3838architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
3839@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3840
3841@kindex info args
3842@item info args
3843Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
3844
3845@item info locals
3846@kindex info locals
3847Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
3848line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
3849accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
3850
c906108c 3851@kindex info catch
d4f3574e
SS
3852@cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
3853@cindex exception handlers, how to list
c906108c
SS
3854@item info catch
3855Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
3856current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
3857exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
3858@code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
3859@xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
53a5351d 3860
c906108c
SS
3861@end table
3862
c906108c 3863
53a5351d 3864@node Source
c906108c
SS
3865@chapter Examining Source Files
3866
3867@value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
3868information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
3869used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
3870the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
3871(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
3872execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
3873source files by explicit command.
3874
7a292a7a 3875If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
d4f3574e 3876prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7a292a7a 3877@value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
c906108c
SS
3878
3879@menu
3880* List:: Printing source lines
c906108c 3881* Search:: Searching source files
c906108c
SS
3882* Source Path:: Specifying source directories
3883* Machine Code:: Source and machine code
3884@end menu
3885
53a5351d 3886@node List
c906108c
SS
3887@section Printing source lines
3888
3889@kindex list
3890@kindex l
3891To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
3892(abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
3893There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
3894
3895Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
3896
3897@table @code
3898@item list @var{linenum}
3899Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
3900current source file.
3901
3902@item list @var{function}
3903Print lines centered around the beginning of function
3904@var{function}.
3905
3906@item list
3907Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
3908@code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
3909printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
3910as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
3911Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
3912
3913@item list -
3914Print lines just before the lines last printed.
3915@end table
3916
3917By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
3918the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
3919
3920@table @code
3921@kindex set listsize
3922@item set listsize @var{count}
3923Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
3924the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
3925
3926@kindex show listsize
3927@item show listsize
3928Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
3929@end table
3930
3931Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
3932so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
3933than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
3934argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
3935each repetition moves up in the source file.
3936
3937@cindex linespec
3938In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
3939@dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
d4f3574e 3940of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
c906108c
SS
3941Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
3942
3943@table @code
3944@item list @var{linespec}
3945Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
3946
3947@item list @var{first},@var{last}
3948Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
3949linespecs.
3950
3951@item list ,@var{last}
3952Print lines ending with @var{last}.
3953
3954@item list @var{first},
3955Print lines starting with @var{first}.
3956
3957@item list +
3958Print lines just after the lines last printed.
3959
3960@item list -
3961Print lines just before the lines last printed.
3962
3963@item list
3964As described in the preceding table.
3965@end table
3966
3967Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
3968kinds of linespec.
3969
3970@table @code
3971@item @var{number}
3972Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
3973When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
3974the same source file as the first linespec.
3975
3976@item +@var{offset}
3977Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
3978When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
3979two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
3980first linespec.
3981
3982@item -@var{offset}
3983Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
3984
3985@item @var{filename}:@var{number}
3986Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
3987
3988@item @var{function}
3989Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
3990For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
3991
3992@item @var{filename}:@var{function}
3993Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
3994function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
3995file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
3996identically named functions in different source files.
3997
3998@item *@var{address}
3999Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4000@var{address} may be any expression.
4001@end table
4002
53a5351d 4003@node Search
c906108c
SS
4004@section Searching source files
4005@cindex searching
4006@kindex reverse-search
4007
4008There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
4009regular expression.
4010
4011@table @code
4012@kindex search
4013@kindex forward-search
4014@item forward-search @var{regexp}
4015@itemx search @var{regexp}
4016The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
4017starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
4018@var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
4019synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
4020@code{fo}.
4021
4022@item reverse-search @var{regexp}
4023The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
4024with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
4025for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
4026this command as @code{rev}.
4027@end table
c906108c 4028
53a5351d 4029@node Source Path
c906108c
SS
4030@section Specifying source directories
4031
4032@cindex source path
4033@cindex directories for source files
4034Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
4035files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
4036the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
4037session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
4038this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
4039it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
4040in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name. Note that
4041the executable search path is @emph{not} used for this purpose. Neither is
4042the current working directory, unless it happens to be in the source
4043path.
4044
4045If @value{GDBN} cannot find a source file in the source path, and the
4046object program records a directory, @value{GDBN} tries that directory
4047too. If the source path is empty, and there is no record of the
4048compilation directory, @value{GDBN} looks in the current directory as a
4049last resort.
4050
4051Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
4052any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
4053each line is in the file.
4054
4055@kindex directory
4056@kindex dir
d4f3574e
SS
4057When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
4058and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
c906108c
SS
4059To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
4060
4061@table @code
4062@item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
4063@item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
4064Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
d4f3574e
SS
4065directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
4066(@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
4067part of absolute file names) or
c906108c
SS
4068whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
4069path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
4070
4071@kindex cdir
4072@kindex cwd
4073@kindex $cdir
4074@kindex $cwd
4075@cindex compilation directory
4076@cindex current directory
4077@cindex working directory
4078@cindex directory, current
4079@cindex directory, compilation
4080You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
4081directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
4082working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
4083tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
4084session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
4085directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
4086
4087@item directory
4088Reset the source path to empty again. This requires confirmation.
4089
4090@c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
4091@c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
4092
4093@item show directories
4094@kindex show directories
4095Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
4096@end table
4097
4098If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
4099interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
4100versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
4101
4102@enumerate
4103@item
4104Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to empty.
4105
4106@item
4107Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
4108directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
4109directories in one command.
4110@end enumerate
4111
53a5351d 4112@node Machine Code
c906108c
SS
4113@section Source and machine code
4114
4115You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
4116addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
4117a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
d4f3574e 4118mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
c906108c
SS
4119line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
4120well as hex.
4121
4122@table @code
4123@kindex info line
4124@item info line @var{linespec}
4125Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
4126source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
4127the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
4128source lines}).
4129@end table
4130
4131For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
4132the object code for the first line of function
4133@code{m4_changequote}:
4134
d4f3574e
SS
4135@c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
4136@c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
c906108c 4137@smallexample
96a2c332 4138(@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
c906108c
SS
4139Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
4140@end smallexample
4141
4142@noindent
4143We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
4144@var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
4145@smallexample
4146(@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
4147Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
4148@end smallexample
4149
4150@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
d4f3574e 4151@kindex x@r{, and }@code{info line}
c906108c
SS
4152After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
4153is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
4154sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
4155,Examining memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
4156convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4157variables}).
4158
4159@table @code
4160@kindex disassemble
4161@cindex assembly instructions
4162@cindex instructions, assembly
4163@cindex machine instructions
4164@cindex listing machine instructions
4165@item disassemble
4166This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
4167instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
4168program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
4169command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
4170surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
4171(first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
4172@end table
4173
c906108c
SS
4174The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
4175HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
4176
4177@smallexample
4178(@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
4179Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
41800x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
41810x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
41820x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
41830x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
41840x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
41850x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
41860x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
41870x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4188End of assembler dump.
4189@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4190
4191Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
4192mnemonics or other syntax.
4193
4194@table @code
d4f3574e 4195@kindex set disassembly-flavor
c906108c
SS
4196@cindex assembly instructions
4197@cindex instructions, assembly
4198@cindex machine instructions
4199@cindex listing machine instructions
d4f3574e
SS
4200@cindex Intel disassembly flavor
4201@cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
4202@item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
c906108c
SS
4203Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
4204program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
4205
4206Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
d4f3574e
SS
4207can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
4208The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
4209assemblers for x86-based targets.
c906108c
SS
4210@end table
4211
4212
53a5351d 4213@node Data
c906108c
SS
4214@chapter Examining Data
4215
4216@cindex printing data
4217@cindex examining data
4218@kindex print
4219@kindex inspect
4220@c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
4221@c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
4222@c different window or something like that.
4223The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
7a292a7a
SS
4224command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
4225evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
4226program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
4227Different Languages}).
c906108c
SS
4228
4229@table @code
d4f3574e
SS
4230@item print @var{expr}
4231@itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
4232@var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
4233value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
c906108c 4234you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
d4f3574e 4235@var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
c906108c
SS
4236formats}.
4237
4238@item print
4239@itemx print /@var{f}
d4f3574e 4240If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
c906108c
SS
4241@dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value history}). This allows you to
4242conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
4243@end table
4244
4245A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
4246It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
4247specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4248
7a292a7a 4249If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
d4f3574e
SS
4250fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
4251command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
7a292a7a 4252Table}.
c906108c
SS
4253
4254@menu
4255* Expressions:: Expressions
4256* Variables:: Program variables
4257* Arrays:: Artificial arrays
4258* Output Formats:: Output formats
4259* Memory:: Examining memory
4260* Auto Display:: Automatic display
4261* Print Settings:: Print settings
4262* Value History:: Value history
4263* Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
4264* Registers:: Registers
c906108c 4265* Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
c906108c
SS
4266@end menu
4267
53a5351d 4268@node Expressions
c906108c
SS
4269@section Expressions
4270
4271@cindex expressions
4272@code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
4273compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
4274by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
4275@value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls, casts
4276and string constants. It unfortunately does not include symbols defined
4277by preprocessor @code{#define} commands.
4278
d4f3574e
SS
4279@value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
4280the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
4281you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
4282memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
c906108c 4283
c906108c
SS
4284Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
4285this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
4286Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
4287languages.
4288
4289In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
4290expressions regardless of your programming language.
4291
4292Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
4293useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
4294at that address in memory.
4295@c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
c906108c
SS
4296
4297@value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
4298to programming languages:
4299
4300@table @code
4301@item @@
4302@samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
4303@xref{Arrays, ,Artificial arrays}, for more information.
4304
4305@item ::
4306@samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
4307function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program variables}.
4308
4309@cindex @{@var{type}@}
4310@cindex type casting memory
4311@cindex memory, viewing as typed object
4312@cindex casts, to view memory
4313@item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
4314Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
4315memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
4316pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
4317a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
4318normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
4319@end table
4320
53a5351d 4321@node Variables
c906108c
SS
4322@section Program variables
4323
4324The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
4325in your program.
4326
4327Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
4328(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}); they must be either:
4329
4330@itemize @bullet
4331@item
4332global (or file-static)
4333@end itemize
4334
4335@noindent or
4336
4337@itemize @bullet
4338@item
4339visible according to the scope rules of the
4340programming language from the point of execution in that frame
4341@end itemize
4342
4343@noindent This means that in the function
4344
4345@example
4346foo (a)
4347 int a;
4348@{
4349 bar (a);
4350 @{
4351 int b = test ();
4352 bar (b);
4353 @}
4354@}
4355@end example
4356
4357@noindent
4358you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
4359executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
4360examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
4361the block where @code{b} is declared.
4362
4363@cindex variable name conflict
4364There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
4365scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
4366in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
4367function with the same name (in different source files). If that
4368happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
4369you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
4370using the colon-colon notation:
4371
d4f3574e 4372@cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
c906108c
SS
4373@iftex
4374@c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
4375@kindex ::
4376@end iftex
4377@example
4378@var{file}::@var{variable}
4379@var{function}::@var{variable}
4380@end example
4381
4382@noindent
4383Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
4384static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
4385make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
4386to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
4387
4388@example
4389(@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
4390@end example
4391
c906108c
SS
4392@cindex C++ scope resolution
4393This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
4394use of the same notation in C++. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C++
4395scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
4396@c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
4397@c conflict?? --mew
c906108c
SS
4398
4399@cindex wrong values
4400@cindex variable values, wrong
4401@quotation
4402@emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
4403wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
4404scope, and just before exit.
4405@end quotation
4406You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
4407This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
4408set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
4409stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
4410values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
4411also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
4412after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
4413variable definitions may be gone.
4414
4415This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
4416To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
4417when compiling.
4418
d4f3574e
SS
4419@cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
4420Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
4421unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
4422opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
4423offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
4424might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
4425happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
4426
4427@example
4428No symbol "foo" in current context.
4429@end example
4430
4431To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
4432different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
4433formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C++ compiler usually
4434supports the @samp{-gstabs} option. @samp{-gstabs} produces debug info
4435in a format that is superior to formats such as COFF. You may be able
4436to use DWARF-2 (@samp{-gdwarf-2}), which is also an effective form for
4437debug info. See @ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your
4438Program or @sc{gnu} CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more
4439information.
4440
4441
53a5351d 4442@node Arrays
c906108c
SS
4443@section Artificial arrays
4444
4445@cindex artificial array
4446@kindex @@
4447It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
4448same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
4449dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
4450program.
4451
4452You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
4453@dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
4454operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
4455and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
4456of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
4457the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
4458argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
4459following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
4460example. If a program says
4461
4462@example
4463int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
4464@end example
4465
4466@noindent
4467you can print the contents of @code{array} with
4468
4469@example
4470p *array@@len
4471@end example
4472
4473The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
4474with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
4475subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
4476Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
4477(@pxref{Value History, ,Value history}), after printing one out.
4478
4479Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
4480This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
4481The value need not be in memory:
4482@example
4483(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
4484$1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4485@end example
4486
4487As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
c3f6f71d 4488@samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
c906108c
SS
4489the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
4490@example
4491(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
4492$2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4493@end example
4494
4495Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
4496moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
4497actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
4498of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
4499to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4500variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
4501interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
4502instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
4503structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
4504in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
4505
4506@example
4507set $i = 0
4508p dtab[$i++]->fv
4509@key{RET}
4510@key{RET}
4511@dots{}
4512@end example
4513
53a5351d 4514@node Output Formats
c906108c
SS
4515@section Output formats
4516
4517@cindex formatted output
4518@cindex output formats
4519By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
4520this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
4521in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
4522at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
4523these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
4524
4525The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
4526already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
4527@code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
4528letters supported are:
4529
4530@table @code
4531@item x
4532Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
4533hexadecimal.
4534
4535@item d
4536Print as integer in signed decimal.
4537
4538@item u
4539Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
4540
4541@item o
4542Print as integer in octal.
4543
4544@item t
4545Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
4546@footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
4547used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
d4f3574e 4548see @ref{Memory,,Examining memory}.}
c906108c
SS
4549
4550@item a
4551@cindex unknown address, locating
4552Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
4553the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
4554where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
4555
4556@example
4557(@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
4558$3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
4559@end example
4560
4561@item c
4562Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant.
4563
4564@item f
4565Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
4566using typical floating point syntax.
4567@end table
4568
4569For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
4570
4571@example
4572p/x $pc
4573@end example
4574
4575@noindent
4576Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
4577names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
4578
4579To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
4580you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
4581expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
4582
53a5351d 4583@node Memory
c906108c
SS
4584@section Examining memory
4585
4586You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
4587any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
4588
4589@cindex examining memory
4590@table @code
4591@kindex x
4592@item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
4593@itemx x @var{addr}
4594@itemx x
4595Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
4596@end table
4597
4598@var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
4599much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
4600expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
4601If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
4602Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
4603
4604@table @r
4605@item @var{n}, the repeat count
4606The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
4607how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
4608@c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
4609@c 4.1.2.
4610
4611@item @var{f}, the display format
4612The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print},
4613@samp{s} (null-terminated string), or @samp{i} (machine instruction).
4614The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially.
4615The default changes each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
4616
4617@item @var{u}, the unit size
4618The unit size is any of
4619
4620@table @code
4621@item b
4622Bytes.
4623@item h
4624Halfwords (two bytes).
4625@item w
4626Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
4627@item g
4628Giant words (eight bytes).
4629@end table
4630
4631Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
4632default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
4633@samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
4634
4635@item @var{addr}, starting display address
4636@var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
4637memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
4638it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
4639@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
4640@var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
4641other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
4642the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
4643starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
4644a value from memory).
4645@end table
4646
4647For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
4648(@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
4649starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
4650words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
d4f3574e 4651@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
c906108c
SS
4652
4653Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
4654letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
4655unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
4656specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
4657(However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
4658
4659Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
4660and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
4661@samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
4662including any operands. The command @code{disassemble} gives an
d4f3574e 4663alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
c906108c
SS
4664Code,,Source and machine code}.
4665
4666All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
4667easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
4668you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
4669instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
4670with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
4671the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
4672for successive uses of @code{x}.
4673
4674@cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
4675The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
4676in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
4677would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
4678subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
4679@code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
4680examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
4681@code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
4682the convenience variable @code{$__}.
4683
4684If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
4685are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
4686address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
4687
53a5351d 4688@node Auto Display
c906108c
SS
4689@section Automatic display
4690@cindex automatic display
4691@cindex display of expressions
4692
4693If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
4694(to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
4695display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
4696Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
4697to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
4698The automatic display looks like this:
4699
4700@example
47012: foo = 38
47023: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
4703@end example
4704
4705@noindent
4706This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
4707displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
4708specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
4709whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
4710format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
4711or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
4712supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
4713
4714@table @code
4715@kindex display
d4f3574e
SS
4716@item display @var{expr}
4717Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
c906108c
SS
4718each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4719
4720@code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
4721
d4f3574e 4722@item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
c906108c 4723For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
d4f3574e 4724count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
c906108c
SS
4725arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
4726@xref{Output Formats,,Output formats}.
4727
4728@item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
4729For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
4730number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
4731be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
4732doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4733@end table
4734
4735For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
4736instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
d4f3574e 4737is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
4738
4739@table @code
4740@kindex delete display
4741@kindex undisplay
4742@item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
4743@itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4744Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
4745
4746@code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
4747(Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
4748
4749@kindex disable display
4750@item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4751Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
4752item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
4753enabled again later.
4754
4755@kindex enable display
4756@item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4757Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
4758again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
4759
4760@item display
4761Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
4762done when your program stops.
4763
4764@kindex info display
4765@item info display
4766Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
4767automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
4768values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
4769It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
4770because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
4771@end table
4772
4773If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
4774sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
4775expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
4776variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
4777@code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
4778@code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
4779continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
4780there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
4781automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
4782is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
4783
53a5351d 4784@node Print Settings
c906108c
SS
4785@section Print settings
4786
4787@cindex format options
4788@cindex print settings
4789@value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
4790and symbols are printed.
4791
4792@noindent
4793These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
4794
4795@table @code
4796@kindex set print address
4797@item set print address
4798@itemx set print address on
4799@value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
4800traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
4801even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
4802is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
4803@code{set print address on}:
4804
4805@smallexample
4806@group
4807(@value{GDBP}) f
4808#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
4809 at input.c:530
4810530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
4811@end group
4812@end smallexample
4813
4814@item set print address off
4815Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
4816this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
4817
4818@smallexample
4819@group
4820(@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
4821(@value{GDBP}) f
4822#0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
4823530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
4824@end group
4825@end smallexample
4826
4827You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
4828dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
4829@code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
4830all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
4831
4832@kindex show print address
4833@item show print address
4834Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
4835@end table
4836
4837When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
4838closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
4839identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
4840source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
4841@code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
4842you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
4843it prints a symbolic address:
4844
4845@table @code
4846@kindex set print symbol-filename
4847@item set print symbol-filename on
4848Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
4849symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
4850
4851@item set print symbol-filename off
4852Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
4853default.
4854
4855@kindex show print symbol-filename
4856@item show print symbol-filename
4857Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
4858line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
4859@end table
4860
4861Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
4862numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
4863number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
4864
4865Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
4866printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
4867
4868@table @code
4869@kindex set print max-symbolic-offset
4870@item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
4871Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
4872offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
4873@var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
4874to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
4875
4876@kindex show print max-symbolic-offset
4877@item show print max-symbolic-offset
4878Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
4879symbolic address.
4880@end table
4881
4882@cindex wild pointer, interpreting
4883@cindex pointer, finding referent
4884If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
4885@samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
4886and source file location of the variable where it points, using
4887@samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
4888For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
4889at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
4890
4891@example
4892(@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
4893(@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
4894$4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
4895@end example
4896
4897@quotation
4898@emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
4899does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
4900the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
4901@end quotation
4902
4903Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
4904
4905@table @code
4906@kindex set print array
4907@item set print array
4908@itemx set print array on
4909Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
4910but uses more space. The default is off.
4911
4912@item set print array off
4913Return to compressed format for arrays.
4914
4915@kindex show print array
4916@item show print array
4917Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
4918arrays.
4919
4920@kindex set print elements
4921@item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
4922Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
4923If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
4924printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
4925This limit also applies to the display of strings.
d4f3574e 4926When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
c906108c
SS
4927Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
4928
4929@kindex show print elements
4930@item show print elements
4931Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
4932If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
4933
4934@kindex set print null-stop
4935@item set print null-stop
4936Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
d4f3574e 4937@sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
c906108c 4938contain only short strings.
d4f3574e 4939The default is off.
c906108c
SS
4940
4941@kindex set print pretty
4942@item set print pretty on
4943Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
4944per line, like this:
4945
4946@smallexample
4947@group
4948$1 = @{
4949 next = 0x0,
4950 flags = @{
4951 sweet = 1,
4952 sour = 1
4953 @},
4954 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
4955@}
4956@end group
4957@end smallexample
4958
4959@item set print pretty off
4960Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
4961
4962@smallexample
4963@group
4964$1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
4965meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
4966@end group
4967@end smallexample
4968
4969@noindent
4970This is the default format.
4971
4972@kindex show print pretty
4973@item show print pretty
4974Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
4975
4976@kindex set print sevenbit-strings
4977@item set print sevenbit-strings on
4978Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
4979@value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
4980character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
4981best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
4982high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
4983
4984@item set print sevenbit-strings off
4985Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
4986international character sets, and is the default.
4987
4988@kindex show print sevenbit-strings
4989@item show print sevenbit-strings
4990Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
4991
4992@kindex set print union
4993@item set print union on
4994Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures. This
4995is the default setting.
4996
4997@item set print union off
4998Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in structures.
4999
5000@kindex show print union
5001@item show print union
5002Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
5003structures.
5004
5005For example, given the declarations
5006
5007@smallexample
5008typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
5009typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
5010typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
5011 Bug_forms;
5012
5013struct thing @{
5014 Species it;
5015 union @{
5016 Tree_forms tree;
5017 Bug_forms bug;
5018 @} form;
5019@};
5020
5021struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
5022@end smallexample
5023
5024@noindent
5025with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
5026
5027@smallexample
5028$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
5029@end smallexample
5030
5031@noindent
5032and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
5033
5034@smallexample
5035$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
5036@end smallexample
5037@end table
5038
c906108c
SS
5039@need 1000
5040@noindent
5041These settings are of interest when debugging C++ programs:
5042
5043@table @code
5044@cindex demangling
5045@kindex set print demangle
5046@item set print demangle
5047@itemx set print demangle on
5048Print C++ names in their source form rather than in the encoded
5049(``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
d4f3574e 5050linkage. The default is on.
c906108c
SS
5051
5052@kindex show print demangle
5053@item show print demangle
5054Show whether C++ names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
5055
5056@kindex set print asm-demangle
5057@item set print asm-demangle
5058@itemx set print asm-demangle on
5059Print C++ names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
5060in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
5061The default is off.
5062
5063@kindex show print asm-demangle
5064@item show print asm-demangle
5065Show whether C++ names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
5066or demangled form.
5067
5068@kindex set demangle-style
5069@cindex C++ symbol decoding style
5070@cindex symbol decoding style, C++
5071@item set demangle-style @var{style}
5072Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
5073represent C++ names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
5074
5075@table @code
5076@item auto
5077Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
5078
5079@item gnu
5080Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C++ compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c 5081This is the default.
c906108c
SS
5082
5083@item hp
5084Decode based on the HP ANSI C++ (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
5085
5086@item lucid
5087Decode based on the Lucid C++ compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
5088
5089@item arm
5090Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C++ Annotated Reference Manual}.
5091@strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
5092debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
5093require further enhancement to permit that.
5094
5095@end table
5096If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
5097
5098@kindex show demangle-style
5099@item show demangle-style
5100Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C++ symbols.
5101
5102@kindex set print object
5103@item set print object
5104@itemx set print object on
5105When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
5106(derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
5107the virtual function table.
5108
5109@item set print object off
5110Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
5111virtual function table. This is the default setting.
5112
5113@kindex show print object
5114@item show print object
5115Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
5116
5117@kindex set print static-members
5118@item set print static-members
5119@itemx set print static-members on
5120Print static members when displaying a C++ object. The default is on.
5121
5122@item set print static-members off
5123Do not print static members when displaying a C++ object.
5124
5125@kindex show print static-members
5126@item show print static-members
5127Show whether C++ static members are printed, or not.
5128
5129@c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
5130@kindex set print vtbl
5131@item set print vtbl
5132@itemx set print vtbl on
5133Pretty print C++ virtual function tables. The default is off.
c906108c
SS
5134(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
5135ANSI C++ compiler (@code{aCC}).)
c906108c
SS
5136
5137@item set print vtbl off
5138Do not pretty print C++ virtual function tables.
5139
5140@kindex show print vtbl
5141@item show print vtbl
5142Show whether C++ virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
5143@end table
c906108c 5144
53a5351d 5145@node Value History
c906108c
SS
5146@section Value history
5147
5148@cindex value history
5149Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
5150@dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
5151Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
5152(for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
5153When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
5154since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
5155symbol table.
5156
5157@cindex @code{$}
5158@cindex @code{$$}
5159@cindex history number
5160The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
5161refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
5162@code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
5163printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
5164history number.
5165
5166To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
5167history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
5168remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
5169the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
5170@code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
5171is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
5172@code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
5173
5174For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
5175want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
5176
5177@example
5178p *$
5179@end example
5180
5181If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
5182to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
5183
5184@example
5185p *$.next
5186@end example
5187
5188@noindent
5189You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
5190command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
5191
5192Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
5193@code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
5194
5195@example
5196print x
5197set x=5
5198@end example
5199
5200@noindent
5201then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
5202remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
5203
5204@table @code
5205@kindex show values
5206@item show values
5207Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
5208This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
5209values} does not change the history.
5210
5211@item show values @var{n}
5212Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
5213
5214@item show values +
5215Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
5216values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
5217@end table
5218
5219Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
5220same effect as @samp{show values +}.
5221
53a5351d 5222@node Convenience Vars
c906108c
SS
5223@section Convenience variables
5224
5225@cindex convenience variables
5226@value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
5227@value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
5228exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
5229setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
5230of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
5231
5232Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
5233@samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
d4f3574e 5234the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
5235(Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
5236by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value history}.)
5237
5238You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
5239expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
5240For example:
5241
5242@example
5243set $foo = *object_ptr
5244@end example
5245
5246@noindent
5247would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
5248@code{object_ptr}.
5249
5250Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
5251value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
5252value with another assignment at any time.
5253
5254Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
5255variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
5256that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
5257variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
5258
5259@table @code
5260@kindex show convenience
5261@item show convenience
5262Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
d4f3574e 5263Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
c906108c
SS
5264@end table
5265
5266One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
5267incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
5268a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
5269
5270@example
5271set $i = 0
5272print bar[$i++]->contents
5273@end example
5274
d4f3574e
SS
5275@noindent
5276Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
c906108c
SS
5277
5278Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
5279values likely to be useful.
5280
5281@table @code
5282@kindex $_
5283@item $_
5284The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
5285the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}). Other
5286commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
5287set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
5288and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
5289except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
5290to the type of @code{$__}.
5291
5292@kindex $__
5293@item $__
5294The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
5295to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
5296to match the format in which the data was printed.
5297
5298@item $_exitcode
5299@kindex $_exitcode
5300The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
5301the program being debugged terminates.
5302@end table
5303
53a5351d
JM
5304On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
5305begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
5306name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
c906108c 5307
53a5351d 5308@node Registers
c906108c
SS
5309@section Registers
5310
5311@cindex registers
5312You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
5313with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
5314for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
5315your machine.
5316
5317@table @code
5318@kindex info registers
5319@item info registers
5320Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
5321registers (in the selected stack frame).
5322
5323@kindex info all-registers
5324@cindex floating point registers
5325@item info all-registers
5326Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
5327registers.
5328
5329@item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
5330Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
5331As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
5332the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
5333the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
5334@end table
5335
5336@value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
5337expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
5338architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
5339@code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
5340the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
5341pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
5342register that contains the processor status. For example,
5343you could print the program counter in hex with
5344
5345@example
5346p/x $pc
5347@end example
5348
5349@noindent
5350or print the instruction to be executed next with
5351
5352@example
5353x/i $pc
5354@end example
5355
5356@noindent
5357or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
5358one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
5359memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
5360stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
5361stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
5362regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
d4f3574e 5363see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}.} with
c906108c
SS
5364
5365@example
5366set $sp += 4
5367@end example
5368
5369Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
5370your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
5371so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
5372shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
5373registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
d4f3574e
SS
5374can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
5375is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
c906108c
SS
5376
5377@value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
5378integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
5379special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
5380registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
5381to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
5382(although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
5383@samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
5384
5385Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
5386means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
5387the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
5388sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
5389coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
5390programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
5391cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
5392that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
5393prints the data in both formats.
5394
5395Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
5396(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). This means that you get the
5397value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
5398were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
5399true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
5400frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
5401
5402However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
5403code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
5404@value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
5405frame makes no difference.
5406
53a5351d 5407@node Floating Point Hardware
c906108c
SS
5408@section Floating point hardware
5409@cindex floating point
5410
5411Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
5412you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
5413
5414@table @code
5415@kindex info float
5416@item info float
5417Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
5418point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
5419floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
5420the ARM and x86 machines.
5421@end table
c906108c 5422
53a5351d 5423@node Languages
c906108c
SS
5424@chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
5425@cindex languages
5426
c906108c
SS
5427Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
5428rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
5429dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
5430Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
5431represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
5432@samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
c906108c
SS
5433
5434@cindex working language
5435Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
5436allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
5437native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
5438consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
5439language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
5440language}.
5441
5442@menu
5443* Setting:: Switching between source languages
5444* Show:: Displaying the language
c906108c 5445* Checks:: Type and range checks
c906108c
SS
5446* Support:: Supported languages
5447@end menu
5448
53a5351d 5449@node Setting
c906108c
SS
5450@section Switching between source languages
5451
5452There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
5453set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
5454@code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
5455defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
5456used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
5457are printed, etc.
5458
5459In addition to the working language, every source file that
5460@value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
5461file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
5462source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
5463language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
5464controls whether C++ names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
5465show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
d4f3574e
SS
5466set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
5467set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
5468Displaying the language}.
c906108c
SS
5469
5470This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
5471as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
5472another language. In that case, make the
5473program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
5474@value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
5475program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
5476
5477@menu
5478* Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
5479* Manually:: Setting the working language manually
5480* Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
5481@end menu
5482
53a5351d 5483@node Filenames
c906108c
SS
5484@subsection List of filename extensions and languages
5485
5486If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
5487@value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
5488
5489@table @file
5490
5491@item .c
5492C source file
5493
5494@item .C
5495@itemx .cc
5496@itemx .cp
5497@itemx .cpp
5498@itemx .cxx
5499@itemx .c++
5500C++ source file
5501
5502@item .f
5503@itemx .F
5504Fortran source file
5505
c906108c
SS
5506@item .ch
5507@itemx .c186
5508@itemx .c286
96a2c332 5509CHILL source file
c906108c 5510
c906108c
SS
5511@item .mod
5512Modula-2 source file
c906108c
SS
5513
5514@item .s
5515@itemx .S
5516Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
5517@value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
5518@end table
5519
5520In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
5521extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the language}.
5522
53a5351d 5523@node Manually
c906108c
SS
5524@subsection Setting the working language
5525
5526If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
5527expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
5528your program.
5529
5530@kindex set language
5531If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
5532command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
5533a language, such as
c906108c 5534@code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
c906108c
SS
5535For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
5536
c906108c
SS
5537Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
5538language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
5539to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
5540source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
5541languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
5542source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
5543command such as:
5544
5545@example
5546print a = b + c
5547@end example
5548
5549@noindent
5550might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
5551@code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
5552printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
5553@code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
c906108c 5554
53a5351d 5555@node Automatically
c906108c
SS
5556@subsection Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
5557
5558To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
5559@samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
5560then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
5561frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
5562working language to the language recorded for the function in that
5563frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
5564or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
5565does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
5566not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
5567
5568This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
5569entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
5570written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
5571a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
5572case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
5573
53a5351d 5574@node Show
c906108c 5575@section Displaying the language
c906108c
SS
5576
5577The following commands help you find out which language is the
5578working language, and also what language source files were written in.
5579
5580@kindex show language
d4f3574e
SS
5581@kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
5582@kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
c906108c
SS
5583@table @code
5584@item show language
5585Display the current working language. This is the
5586language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
5587build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
5588
5589@item info frame
5590Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
5591working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
5592@xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}, to identify the other
5593information listed here.
5594
5595@item info source
5596Display the source language of this source file.
5597@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
5598information listed here.
5599@end table
5600
5601In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
5602not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
5603with a language explicitly:
5604
5605@kindex set extension-language
5606@kindex info extensions
5607@table @code
5608@item set extension-language @var{.ext} @var{language}
5609Set source files with extension @var{.ext} to be assumed to be in
5610the source language @var{language}.
5611
5612@item info extensions
5613List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
5614@end table
5615
53a5351d 5616@node Checks
c906108c
SS
5617@section Type and range checking
5618
5619@quotation
5620@emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
5621checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
5622section documents the intended facilities.
5623@end quotation
5624@c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
5625
5626Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
5627errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
5628checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
5629sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
5630these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
5631by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
5632errors when your program is running.
5633
5634@value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
5635Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program, it
5636can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via
5637the @code{print} command, for example. As with the working language,
5638@value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check automatically based on
5639your program's source language. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages},
5640for the default settings of supported languages.
5641
5642@menu
5643* Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
5644* Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
5645@end menu
5646
5647@cindex type checking
5648@cindex checks, type
53a5351d 5649@node Type Checking
c906108c
SS
5650@subsection An overview of type checking
5651
5652Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
5653arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
5654otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
5655errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
5656
5657@smallexample
56581 + 2 @result{} 3
5659@exdent but
5660@error{} 1 + 2.3
5661@end smallexample
5662
5663The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
5664type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
5665
5666For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
5667@value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
5668to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
5669or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
5670but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
5671these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
5672also issues a warning.
5673
5674Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
5675related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
5676For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
5677a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
5678with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
5679the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
5680
5681Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
5682instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
5683operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
5684represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
5685operators. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for further
5686details on specific languages.
5687
5688@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
5689
d4f3574e 5690@kindex set check@r{, type}
c906108c
SS
5691@kindex set check type
5692@kindex show check type
5693@table @code
5694@item set check type auto
5695Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
5696@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
5697each language.
5698
5699@item set check type on
5700@itemx set check type off
5701Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
5702current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
5703match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
d4f3574e 5704evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
c906108c
SS
5705message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
5706
5707@item set check type warn
5708Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
5709evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
5710be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
5711numbers and structures.
5712
5713@item show type
5714Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
5715is setting it automatically.
5716@end table
5717
5718@cindex range checking
5719@cindex checks, range
53a5351d 5720@node Range Checking
c906108c
SS
5721@subsection An overview of range checking
5722
5723In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
5724bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
5725checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
5726computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
5727not exceed the bounds of the array.
5728
5729For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
5730@value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
5731always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
5732warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
5733
5734A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
5735array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
5736of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
5737error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
5738result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
5739the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
5740
5741@example
5742@var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
5743@end example
5744
5745This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
5746specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Support, ,
5747Supported languages}, for further details on specific languages.
5748
5749@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
5750
d4f3574e 5751@kindex set check@r{, range}
c906108c
SS
5752@kindex set check range
5753@kindex show check range
5754@table @code
5755@item set check range auto
5756Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
5757@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
5758each language.
5759
5760@item set check range on
5761@itemx set check range off
5762Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
5763current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
c3f6f71d
JM
5764match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
5765then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
c906108c
SS
5766
5767@item set check range warn
5768Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
5769but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
5770expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
5771memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
5772systems).
5773
5774@item show range
5775Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
5776being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
5777@end table
c906108c 5778
53a5351d 5779@node Support
c906108c 5780@section Supported languages
c906108c 5781
cce74817
JM
5782@value{GDBN} supports C, C++, Fortran, Java, Chill, assembly, and Modula-2.
5783@c This is false ...
c906108c
SS
5784Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
5785language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
5786and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
5787,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
5788language.
5789
5790The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
5791supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
5792tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
5793@value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
5794formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
5795books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
5796language reference or tutorial.
5797
c906108c 5798@menu
7a292a7a 5799* C:: C and C++
cce74817 5800* Modula-2:: Modula-2
104c1213 5801* Chill:: Chill
c906108c
SS
5802@end menu
5803
53a5351d 5804@node C
c906108c 5805@subsection C and C++
7a292a7a 5806
c906108c
SS
5807@cindex C and C++
5808@cindex expressions in C or C++
c906108c
SS
5809
5810Since C and C++ are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
5811to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
5812together.
5813
c906108c
SS
5814@cindex C++
5815@kindex g++
5816@cindex @sc{gnu} C++
5817The C++ debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C++
5818compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C++ code
5819effectively, you must compile your C++ programs with a supported
5820C++ compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C++
5821compiler (@code{aCC}).
5822
5823For best results when using @sc{gnu} C++, use the stabs debugging
5824format. You can select that format explicitly with the @code{g++}
5825command-line options @samp{-gstabs} or @samp{-gstabs+}. See
5826@ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu}
5827CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more information.
c906108c 5828
c906108c
SS
5829@menu
5830* C Operators:: C and C++ operators
5831* C Constants:: C and C++ constants
7a292a7a 5832* C plus plus expressions:: C++ expressions
c906108c 5833* C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C++
c906108c 5834* C Checks:: C and C++ type and range checks
c906108c
SS
5835* Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
5836* Debugging C plus plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C++
5837@end menu
c906108c 5838
53a5351d 5839@node C Operators
c906108c 5840@subsubsection C and C++ operators
7a292a7a
SS
5841
5842@cindex C and C++ operators
c906108c
SS
5843
5844Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
5845@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
5846often defined on groups of types.
5847
c906108c 5848For the purposes of C and C++, the following definitions hold:
c906108c
SS
5849
5850@itemize @bullet
53a5351d 5851
c906108c 5852@item
c906108c
SS
5853@emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
5854specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C++, @code{bool}.
c906108c
SS
5855
5856@item
d4f3574e
SS
5857@emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
5858@code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
c906108c
SS
5859
5860@item
53a5351d 5861@emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
c906108c
SS
5862
5863@item
5864@emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
53a5351d 5865
c906108c
SS
5866@end itemize
5867
5868@noindent
5869The following operators are supported. They are listed here
5870in order of increasing precedence:
5871
5872@table @code
5873@item ,
5874The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
5875are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
5876expression being the last expression evaluated.
5877
5878@item =
5879Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
5880assigned. Defined on scalar types.
5881
5882@item @var{op}=
5883Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
5884and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
d4f3574e 5885@w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
c906108c
SS
5886@var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
5887@code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
5888
5889@item ?:
5890The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
5891of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
5892integral type.
5893
5894@item ||
5895Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
5896
5897@item &&
5898Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
5899
5900@item |
5901Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
5902
5903@item ^
5904Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
5905
5906@item &
5907Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
5908
5909@item ==@r{, }!=
5910Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
5911expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
5912
5913@item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
5914Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
5915Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
5916and non-zero for true.
5917
5918@item <<@r{, }>>
5919left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
5920
5921@item @@
5922The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
5923
5924@item +@r{, }-
5925Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
5926pointer types.
5927
5928@item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
5929Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
5930defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
5931integral types.
5932
5933@item ++@r{, }--
5934Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
5935operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
5936when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
5937operation takes place.
5938
5939@item *
5940Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
5941@code{++}.
5942
5943@item &
5944Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
5945
c906108c
SS
5946For debugging C++, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
5947allowed in the C++ language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
5948(or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
5949where a C++ reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
5950stored.
c906108c
SS
5951
5952@item -
5953Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
5954precedence as @code{++}.
5955
5956@item !
5957Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
5958@code{++}.
5959
5960@item ~
5961Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
5962@code{++}.
5963
5964
5965@item .@r{, }->
5966Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
5967@value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
5968pointer based on the stored type information.
5969Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
5970
c906108c
SS
5971@item .*@r{, }->*
5972Dereferences of pointers to members.
c906108c
SS
5973
5974@item []
5975Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
5976@code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
5977
5978@item ()
5979Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
5980
c906108c 5981@item ::
7a292a7a
SS
5982C++ scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
5983and @code{class} types.
c906108c
SS
5984
5985@item ::
7a292a7a
SS
5986Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
5987(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
5988above.
c906108c
SS
5989@end table
5990
c906108c
SS
5991If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
5992attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
5993predefined meaning.
c906108c 5994
c906108c
SS
5995@menu
5996* C Constants::
5997@end menu
5998
53a5351d 5999@node C Constants
c906108c 6000@subsubsection C and C++ constants
c906108c
SS
6001
6002@cindex C and C++ constants
c906108c 6003
7a292a7a 6004@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C++ in the
c906108c 6005following ways:
c906108c
SS
6006
6007@itemize @bullet
6008@item
6009Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
6010specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e. zero), and hexadecimal constants by
6011a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
6012@samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
6013@code{long} value.
6014
6015@item
6016Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
6017point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
6018exponent. An exponent is of the form:
6019@samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
6020sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
d4f3574e
SS
6021A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
6022@samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
6023the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
6024a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
6025constant.
c906108c
SS
6026
6027@item
6028Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
6029integral equivalents.
6030
6031@item
6032Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
6033(@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
d4f3574e 6034(usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
c906108c
SS
6035be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
6036the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
6037of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
6038@samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
6039@samp{\n} for newline.
6040
6041@item
96a2c332
SS
6042String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
6043double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
6044above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
6045a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
6046characters.
c906108c
SS
6047
6048@item
6049Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
6050to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
6051
6052@item
6053Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
6054and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
6055integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
6056and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
6057@end itemize
6058
c906108c 6059@menu
7a292a7a 6060* C plus plus expressions::
c906108c 6061* C Defaults::
c906108c 6062* C Checks::
c906108c
SS
6063
6064* Debugging C::
6065@end menu
6066
53a5351d 6067@node C plus plus expressions
c906108c 6068@subsubsection C++ expressions
c906108c
SS
6069
6070@cindex expressions in C++
6071@value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C++ expressions.
6072
c906108c
SS
6073@cindex C++ support, not in @sc{coff}
6074@cindex @sc{coff} versus C++
6075@cindex C++ and object formats
6076@cindex object formats and C++
6077@cindex a.out and C++
6078@cindex @sc{ecoff} and C++
6079@cindex @sc{xcoff} and C++
6080@cindex @sc{elf}/stabs and C++
6081@cindex @sc{elf}/@sc{dwarf} and C++
6082@c FIXME!! GDB may eventually be able to debug C++ using DWARF; check
6083@c periodically whether this has happened...
6084@quotation
6085@emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C++ code if you use the
6086proper compiler. Typically, C++ debugging depends on the use of
6087additional debugging information in the symbol table, and thus requires
6088special support. In particular, if your compiler generates a.out, MIPS
6089@sc{ecoff}, RS/6000 @sc{xcoff}, or @sc{elf} with stabs extensions to the
6090symbol table, these facilities are all available. (With @sc{gnu} CC,
6091you can use the @samp{-gstabs} option to request stabs debugging
6092extensions explicitly.) Where the object code format is standard
6093@sc{coff} or @sc{dwarf} in @sc{elf}, on the other hand, most of the C++
6094support in @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} work.
6095@end quotation
c906108c
SS
6096
6097@enumerate
6098
6099@cindex member functions
6100@item
6101Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
6102
6103@example
6104count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
6105@end example
6106
6107@kindex this
6108@cindex namespace in C++
6109@item
6110While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
6111expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
6112that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
6113pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C++.
6114
c906108c 6115@cindex call overloaded functions
d4f3574e 6116@cindex overloaded functions, calling
c906108c
SS
6117@cindex type conversions in C++
6118@item
6119You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
d4f3574e 6120call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
c906108c
SS
6121perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
6122calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
6123in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
6124default arguments.
6125
6126It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
6127promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
6128class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
6129functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
6130number of function arguments.
6131
6132Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
6133@code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C plus plus,
6134,@value{GDBN} features for C++}.
6135
d4f3574e 6136You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
c906108c
SS
6137explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
6138@smallexample
6139p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
6140@end smallexample
d4f3574e 6141
c906108c 6142The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
d4f3574e 6143see @ref{Completion, ,Command completion}.
c906108c 6144
c906108c
SS
6145@cindex reference declarations
6146@item
6147@value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C++ references; you can use
6148them in expressions just as you do in C++ source---they are automatically
6149dereferenced.
6150
6151In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
6152reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
6153avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
6154The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
6155you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
6156
6157@item
6158@value{GDBN} supports the C++ name resolution operator @code{::}---your
6159expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
6160one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
6161necessary, for example in an expression like
6162@samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
6163resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C++
6164debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program variables}).
6165@end enumerate
6166
53a5351d
JM
6167In addition, when used with HP's C++ compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
6168calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
6169objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
6170invoking user-defined operators.
c906108c 6171
53a5351d 6172@node C Defaults
c906108c 6173@subsubsection C and C++ defaults
7a292a7a 6174
c906108c
SS
6175@cindex C and C++ defaults
6176
c906108c
SS
6177If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
6178both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
6179C or C++. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
6180selects the working language.
c906108c
SS
6181
6182If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
6183recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
6184@file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
6185these files, it sets the working language to C or C++.
6186@xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language},
6187for further details.
6188
c906108c
SS
6189@c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
6190@c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
6191@c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
7a292a7a 6192
53a5351d 6193@node C Checks
c906108c 6194@subsubsection C and C++ type and range checks
7a292a7a 6195
c906108c
SS
6196@cindex C and C++ checks
6197
6198By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C++ expressions, type checking
6199is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
6200considers two variables type equivalent if:
6201
6202@itemize @bullet
6203@item
6204The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
6205enumerated tag.
6206
6207@item
6208The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
6209declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
6210
6211@ignore
6212@c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
6213@c FIXME--beers?
6214@item
6215The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
6216declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
6217compilers.)
6218@end ignore
6219@end itemize
6220
6221Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
6222indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
6223that is not itself an array.
c906108c 6224
53a5351d 6225@node Debugging C
c906108c 6226@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
c906108c
SS
6227
6228The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
6229the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
7a292a7a
SS
6230inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
6231appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
c906108c
SS
6232
6233The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
6234with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
6235,Expressions}.
6236
c906108c
SS
6237@menu
6238* Debugging C plus plus::
6239@end menu
6240
53a5351d 6241@node Debugging C plus plus
c906108c 6242@subsubsection @value{GDBN} features for C++
c906108c
SS
6243
6244@cindex commands for C++
7a292a7a 6245
c906108c
SS
6246Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C++, and some are
6247designed specifically for use with C++. Here is a summary:
6248
6249@table @code
6250@cindex break in overloaded functions
6251@item @r{breakpoint menus}
6252When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
6253@value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
6254you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}.
6255
6256@cindex overloading in C++
6257@item rbreak @var{regex}
6258Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
6259breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
6260classes.
6261@xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.
6262
6263@cindex C++ exception handling
6264@item catch throw
6265@itemx catch catch
6266Debug C++ exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
6267Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
6268
6269@cindex inheritance
6270@item ptype @var{typename}
6271Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
6272@var{typename}.
6273@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
6274
6275@cindex C++ symbol display
6276@item set print demangle
6277@itemx show print demangle
6278@itemx set print asm-demangle
6279@itemx show print asm-demangle
6280Control whether C++ symbols display in their source form, both when
6281displaying code as C++ source and when displaying disassemblies.
6282@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
6283
6284@item set print object
6285@itemx show print object
6286Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
6287@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
6288
6289@item set print vtbl
6290@itemx show print vtbl
6291Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
6292@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
c906108c
SS
6293(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
6294ANSI C++ compiler (@code{aCC}).)
6295
6296@kindex set overload-resolution
d4f3574e 6297@cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
c906108c
SS
6298@item set overload-resolution on
6299Enable overload resolution for C++ expression evaluation. The default
6300is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
6301and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
d4f3574e
SS
6302using the standard C++ conversion rules (see @ref{C plus plus expressions, ,C++
6303expressions}, for details). If it cannot find a match, it emits a
c906108c
SS
6304message.
6305
6306@item set overload-resolution off
6307Disable overload resolution for C++ expression evaluation. For
6308overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
6309chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
6310symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
6311overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
6312searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
6313argument types.
c906108c
SS
6314
6315@item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
6316You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
6317the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C++: type
6318@code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
6319also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
6320available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
6321@xref{Completion,, Command completion}, for details on how to do this.
6322@end table
c906108c 6323
53a5351d 6324@node Modula-2
c906108c 6325@subsection Modula-2
7a292a7a 6326
d4f3574e 6327@cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
c906108c
SS
6328
6329The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
6330output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
6331developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
6332attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
6333to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
6334table.
6335
6336@cindex expressions in Modula-2
6337@menu
6338* M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
6339* Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
6340* M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
6341* M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
6342* Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
6343* M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
6344* M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
6345* GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
6346@end menu
6347
53a5351d 6348@node M2 Operators
c906108c
SS
6349@subsubsection Operators
6350@cindex Modula-2 operators
6351
6352Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
6353@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
6354often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
6355following definitions hold:
6356
6357@itemize @bullet
6358
6359@item
6360@emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
6361their subranges.
6362
6363@item
6364@emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
6365
6366@item
6367@emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
6368
6369@item
6370@emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
6371@var{type}}.
6372
6373@item
6374@emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
6375
6376@item
6377@emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
6378
6379@item
6380@emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
6381@end itemize
6382
6383@noindent
6384The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
6385increasing precedence:
6386
6387@table @code
6388@item ,
6389Function argument or array index separator.
6390
6391@item :=
6392Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
6393@var{value}.
6394
6395@item <@r{, }>
6396Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
6397types.
6398
6399@item <=@r{, }>=
96a2c332 6400Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
c906108c
SS
6401on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
6402set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
6403
6404@item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
6405Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
6406Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
6407available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
6408comment character.
6409
6410@item IN
6411Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
6412Same precedence as @code{<}.
6413
6414@item OR
6415Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
6416
6417@item AND@r{, }&
d4f3574e 6418Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
c906108c
SS
6419
6420@item @@
6421The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
6422
6423@item +@r{, }-
6424Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
6425and difference on set types.
6426
6427@item *
6428Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
6429on set types.
6430
6431@item /
6432Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
6433types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
6434
6435@item DIV@r{, }MOD
6436Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
6437precedence as @code{*}.
6438
6439@item -
6440Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
6441
6442@item ^
6443Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
6444
6445@item NOT
6446Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
6447@code{^}.
6448
6449@item .
6450@code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
6451precedence as @code{^}.
6452
6453@item []
6454Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
6455
6456@item ()
6457Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
6458as @code{^}.
6459
6460@item ::@r{, }.
6461@value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
6462@end table
6463
6464@quotation
6465@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
6466treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
6467@code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
6468@code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
6469@end quotation
6470
6471@cindex Modula-2 built-ins
53a5351d 6472@node Built-In Func/Proc
c906108c
SS
6473@subsubsection Built-in functions and procedures
6474
6475Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
6476In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
6477
6478@table @var
6479
6480@item a
6481represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
6482
6483@item c
6484represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
6485
6486@item i
6487represents a variable or constant of integral type.
6488
6489@item m
6490represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
6491same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
6492be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
6493
6494@item n
6495represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
6496
6497@item r
6498represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
6499
6500@item t
6501represents a type.
6502
6503@item v
6504represents a variable.
6505
6506@item x
6507represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
6508explanation of the function for details.
6509@end table
6510
6511All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
6512
6513@table @code
6514@item ABS(@var{n})
6515Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
6516
6517@item CAP(@var{c})
6518If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
c3f6f71d 6519equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
c906108c
SS
6520
6521@item CHR(@var{i})
6522Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
6523
6524@item DEC(@var{v})
c3f6f71d 6525Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
c906108c
SS
6526
6527@item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
6528Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
6529new value.
6530
6531@item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
6532Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
6533set.
6534
6535@item FLOAT(@var{i})
6536Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
6537
6538@item HIGH(@var{a})
6539Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
6540
6541@item INC(@var{v})
c3f6f71d 6542Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
c906108c
SS
6543
6544@item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
6545Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
6546new value.
6547
6548@item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
6549Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
6550there. Returns the new set.
6551
6552@item MAX(@var{t})
6553Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
6554
6555@item MIN(@var{t})
6556Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
6557
6558@item ODD(@var{i})
6559Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
6560
6561@item ORD(@var{x})
6562Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
c3f6f71d
JM
6563value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
6564@sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
c906108c
SS
6565integral, character and enumerated types.
6566
6567@item SIZE(@var{x})
6568Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
6569
6570@item TRUNC(@var{r})
6571Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
6572
6573@item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
6574Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
6575@end table
6576
6577@quotation
6578@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
6579@value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
6580an error.
6581@end quotation
6582
6583@cindex Modula-2 constants
53a5351d 6584@node M2 Constants
c906108c
SS
6585@subsubsection Constants
6586
6587@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
6588ways:
6589
6590@itemize @bullet
6591
6592@item
6593Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
6594expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
6595rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
6596trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
6597
6598@item
6599Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
6600decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
6601then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
6602@samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
6603digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
6604digits.
6605
6606@item
6607Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
6608like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
c3f6f71d 6609also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
c906108c
SS
6610followed by a @samp{C}.
6611
6612@item
6613String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
6614pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
6615Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
6616Constants, ,C and C++ constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
6617sequences.
6618
6619@item
6620Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
6621
6622@item
6623Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
6624@code{FALSE}.
6625
6626@item
6627Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
6628
6629@item
6630Set constants are not yet supported.
6631@end itemize
6632
53a5351d 6633@node M2 Defaults
c906108c
SS
6634@subsubsection Modula-2 defaults
6635@cindex Modula-2 defaults
6636
6637If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
6638both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
d4f3574e 6639Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
6640selected the working language.
6641
6642If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
6643code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
d4f3574e 6644working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
c906108c
SS
6645the language automatically}, for further details.
6646
53a5351d 6647@node Deviations
c906108c
SS
6648@subsubsection Deviations from standard Modula-2
6649@cindex Modula-2, deviations from
6650
6651A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
6652This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
6653
6654@itemize @bullet
6655@item
6656Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
6657integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
6658debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
6659pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
6660through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
6661returned a pointer.)
6662
6663@item
6664C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
6665non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
6666escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
6667printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
6668
6669@item
6670The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
6671argument.
6672
6673@item
6674All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
6675@end itemize
6676
53a5351d 6677@node M2 Checks
c906108c
SS
6678@subsubsection Modula-2 type and range checks
6679@cindex Modula-2 checks
6680
6681@quotation
6682@emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
6683range checking.
6684@end quotation
6685@c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
6686
6687@value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
6688
6689@itemize @bullet
6690@item
6691They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
6692@var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
6693
6694@item
6695They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
6696@sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
6697@end itemize
6698
6699As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
6700whose types are not equivalent is an error.
6701
6702Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
6703index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
6704
53a5351d 6705@node M2 Scope
c906108c
SS
6706@subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
6707@cindex scope
6708@kindex .
6709@cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
6710@ifinfo
d4f3574e 6711@kindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
c906108c
SS
6712@c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
6713@end ifinfo
6714@iftex
6715@kindex ::
6716@end iftex
6717
6718There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
6719(@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
6720similar syntax:
6721
6722@example
6723
6724@var{module} . @var{id}
6725@var{scope} :: @var{id}
6726@end example
6727
6728@noindent
6729where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
6730@var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
6731identifier within your program, except another module.
6732
6733Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
6734specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
6735found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
6736enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
6737
6738Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
6739the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
6740definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
6741an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
6742module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
6743@var{module}.
6744
53a5351d 6745@node GDB/M2
c906108c
SS
6746@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
6747
6748Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
6749Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
6750specifically to C and C++: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
6751@samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
6752apply to C++, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
6753analogue in Modula-2.
6754
6755The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
d4f3574e 6756with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
c906108c
SS
6757intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
6758created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C++. However, because an
6759address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
d4f3574e 6760@samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
c906108c
SS
6761
6762@cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
6763In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
6764interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
c906108c 6765
53a5351d 6766@node Chill
cce74817
JM
6767@subsection Chill
6768
6769The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Chill only support output
d4f3574e 6770from the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler. Other Chill compilers are not currently
cce74817
JM
6771supported, and attempting to debug executables produced by them is most
6772likely to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
6773table.
6774
d4f3574e
SS
6775@c This used to say "... following Chill related topics ...", but since
6776@c menus are not shown in the printed manual, it would look awkward.
6777This section covers the Chill related topics and the features
cce74817
JM
6778of @value{GDBN} which support these topics.
6779
6780@menu
104c1213
JM
6781* How modes are displayed:: How modes are displayed
6782* Locations:: Locations and their accesses
cce74817 6783* Values and their Operations:: Values and their Operations
53a5351d
JM
6784* Chill type and range checks::
6785* Chill defaults::
cce74817
JM
6786@end menu
6787
6788@node How modes are displayed
6789@subsubsection How modes are displayed
6790
6791The Chill Datatype- (Mode) support of @value{GDBN} is directly related
d4f3574e 6792with the functionality of the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler, and therefore deviates
cce74817
JM
6793slightly from the standard specification of the Chill language. The
6794provided modes are:
d4f3574e
SS
6795
6796@c FIXME: this @table's contents effectively disable @code by using @r
6797@c on every @item. So why does it need @code?
cce74817
JM
6798@table @code
6799@item @r{@emph{Discrete modes:}}
6800@itemize @bullet
6801@item
6802@emph{Integer Modes} which are predefined by @code{BYTE, UBYTE, INT,
6803UINT, LONG, ULONG},
6804@item
6805@emph{Boolean Mode} which is predefined by @code{BOOL},
6806@item
6807@emph{Character Mode} which is predefined by @code{CHAR},
6808@item
6809@emph{Set Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{SET}.
6810@smallexample
6811(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
6812type = SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
6813@end smallexample
6814If the type is an unnumbered set the set element values are omitted.
6815@item
6816@emph{Range Mode} which is displayed by @code{type = <basemode>
6817(<lower bound> : <upper bound>)}, where @code{<lower bound>, <upper
6818bound>} can be of any discrete literal expression (e.g. set element
6819names).
6820@end itemize
6821
6822@item @r{@emph{Powerset Mode:}}
6823A Powerset Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{POWERSET} followed by
d4f3574e 6824the member mode of the powerset. The member mode can be any discrete mode.
cce74817
JM
6825@smallexample
6826(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
6827type = POWERSET SET (egon, hugo, otto)
6828@end smallexample
6829
6830@item @r{@emph{Reference Modes:}}
6831@itemize @bullet
6832@item
d4f3574e 6833@emph{Bound Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{REF}
cce74817
JM
6834followed by the mode name to which the reference is bound.
6835@item
6836@emph{Free Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{PTR}.
6837@end itemize
6838
6839@item @r{@emph{Procedure mode}}
6840The procedure mode is displayed by @code{type = PROC(<parameter list>)
6841<return mode> EXCEPTIONS (<exception list>)}. The @code{<parameter
d4f3574e
SS
6842list>} is a list of the parameter modes. @code{<return mode>} indicates
6843the mode of the result of the procedure if any. The exceptionlist lists
cce74817
JM
6844all possible exceptions which can be raised by the procedure.
6845
6846@ignore
6847@item @r{@emph{Instance mode}}
6848The instance mode is represented by a structure, which has a static
6849type, and is therefore not really of interest.
6850@end ignore
6851
6852@item @r{@emph{Synchronization Modes:}}
6853@itemize @bullet
6854@item
6855@emph{Event Mode} which is displayed by @code{EVENT (<event length>)},
6856where @code{(<event length>)} is optional.
6857@item
6858@emph{Buffer Mode} which is displayed by @code{BUFFER (<buffer length>)
6859<buffer element mode>}, where @code{(<buffer length>)} is optional.
6860@end itemize
6861
6862@item @r{@emph{Timing Modes:}}
6863@itemize @bullet
6864@item
6865@emph{Duration Mode} which is predefined by @code{DURATION}
6866@item
6867@emph{Absolute Time Mode} which is predefined by @code{TIME}
6868@end itemize
6869
6870@item @r{@emph{Real Modes:}}
6871Real Modes are predefined with @code{REAL} and @code{LONG_REAL}.
6872
6873@item @r{@emph{String Modes:}}
6874@itemize @bullet
6875@item
6876@emph{Character String Mode} which is displayed by @code{CHARS(<string
6877length>)}, followed by the keyword @code{VARYING} if the String Mode is
6878a varying mode
6879@item
6880@emph{Bit String Mode} which is displayed by @code{BOOLS(<string
6881length>)}.
6882@end itemize
6883
6884@item @r{@emph{Array Mode:}}
6885The Array Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{ARRAY(<range>)}
6886followed by the element mode (which may in turn be an array mode).
6887@smallexample
6888(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
6889type = ARRAY (1:42)
6890 ARRAY (1:20)
6891 SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
6892@end smallexample
6893
6894@item @r{@emph{Structure Mode}}
6895The Structure mode is displayed by the keyword @code{STRUCT(<field
d4f3574e
SS
6896list>)}. The @code{<field list>} consists of names and modes of fields
6897of the structure. Variant structures have the keyword @code{CASE <field>
6898OF <variant fields> ESAC} in their field list. Since the current version
cce74817
JM
6899of the GNU Chill compiler doesn't implement tag processing (no runtime
6900checks of variant fields, and therefore no debugging info), the output
6901always displays all variant fields.
6902@smallexample
6903(@value{GDBP}) ptype str
6904type = STRUCT (
6905 as x,
6906 bs x,
6907 CASE bs OF
6908 (karli):
6909 cs a
6910 (ott):
6911 ds x
6912 ESAC
6913)
6914@end smallexample
6915@end table
6916
6917@node Locations
6918@subsubsection Locations and their accesses
6919
6920A location in Chill is an object which can contain values.
6921
6922A value of a location is generally accessed by the (declared) name of
d4f3574e
SS
6923the location. The output conforms to the specification of values in
6924Chill programs. How values are specified
6925is the topic of the next section, @ref{Values and their Operations}.
cce74817
JM
6926
6927The pseudo-location @code{RESULT} (or @code{result}) can be used to
6928display or change the result of a currently-active procedure:
d4f3574e 6929
cce74817
JM
6930@smallexample
6931set result := EXPR
6932@end smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
6933
6934@noindent
6935This does the same as the Chill action @code{RESULT EXPR} (which
c3f6f71d 6936is not available in @value{GDBN}).
cce74817
JM
6937
6938Values of reference mode locations are printed by @code{PTR(<hex
6939value>)} in case of a free reference mode, and by @code{(REF <reference
d4f3574e 6940mode>) (<hex-value>)} in case of a bound reference. @code{<hex value>}
cce74817
JM
6941represents the address where the reference points to. To access the
6942value of the location referenced by the pointer, use the dereference
d4f3574e 6943operator @samp{->}.
cce74817
JM
6944
6945Values of procedure mode locations are displayed by @code{@{ PROC
6946(<argument modes> ) <return mode> @} <address> <name of procedure
d4f3574e 6947location>}. @code{<argument modes>} is a list of modes according to the
cce74817
JM
6948parameter specification of the procedure and @code{<address>} shows the
6949address of the entry point.
6950
6951@ignore
6952Locations of instance modes are displayed just like a structure with two
6953fields specifying the @emph{process type} and the @emph{copy number} of
6954the investigated instance location@footnote{This comes from the current
d4f3574e
SS
6955implementation of instances. They are implemented as a structure (no
6956na). The output should be something like @code{[<name of the process>;
6957<instance number>]}.}. The field names are @code{__proc_type} and
cce74817
JM
6958@code{__proc_copy}.
6959
6960Locations of synchronization modes are displayed like a structure with
6961the field name @code{__event_data} in case of a event mode location, and
6962like a structure with the field @code{__buffer_data} in case of a buffer
6963mode location (refer to previous paragraph).
6964
6965Structure Mode locations are printed by @code{[.<field name>: <value>,
d4f3574e 6966...]}. The @code{<field name>} corresponds to the structure mode
cce74817 6967definition and the layout of @code{<value>} varies depending of the mode
d4f3574e
SS
6968of the field. If the investigated structure mode location is of variant
6969structure mode, the variant parts of the structure are enclosed in curled
6970braces (@samp{@{@}}). Fields enclosed by @samp{@{,@}} are residing
cce74817 6971on the same memory location and represent the current values of the
d4f3574e 6972memory location in their specific modes. Since no tag processing is done
cce74817 6973all variants are displayed. A variant field is printed by
d4f3574e 6974@code{(<variant name>) = .<field name>: <value>}. (who implements the
cce74817
JM
6975stuff ???)
6976@smallexample
6977(@value{GDBP}) print str1 $4 = [.as: 0, .bs: karli, .<TAG>: { (karli) =
6978[.cs: []], (susi) = [.ds: susi]}]
6979@end smallexample
6980@end ignore
6981
6982Substructures of string mode-, array mode- or structure mode-values
6983(e.g. array slices, fields of structure locations) are accessed using
d4f3574e
SS
6984certain operations which are described in the next section, @ref{Values
6985and their Operations}.
cce74817
JM
6986
6987A location value may be interpreted as having a different mode using the
d4f3574e
SS
6988location conversion. This mode conversion is written as @code{<mode
6989name>(<location>)}. The user has to consider that the sizes of the modes
6990have to be equal otherwise an error occurs. Furthermore, no range
6991checking of the location against the destination mode is performed, and
cce74817 6992therefore the result can be quite confusing.
d4f3574e 6993
cce74817
JM
6994@smallexample
6995(@value{GDBP}) print int (s(3 up 4)) XXX TO be filled in !! XXX
6996@end smallexample
6997
6998@node Values and their Operations
6999@subsubsection Values and their Operations
7000
7001Values are used to alter locations, to investigate complex structures in
7002more detail or to filter relevant information out of a large amount of
d4f3574e
SS
7003data. There are several (mode dependent) operations defined which enable
7004such investigations. These operations are not only applicable to
cce74817 7005constant values but also to locations, which can become quite useful
d4f3574e 7006when debugging complex structures. During parsing the command line
cce74817
JM
7007(e.g. evaluating an expression) @value{GDBN} treats location names as
7008the values behind these locations.
7009
d4f3574e 7010This section describes how values have to be specified and which
cce74817
JM
7011operations are legal to be used with such values.
7012
7013@table @code
7014@item Literal Values
d4f3574e
SS
7015Literal values are specified in the same manner as in @sc{gnu} Chill programs.
7016For detailed specification refer to the @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual
cce74817 7017chapter 1.5.
d4f3574e
SS
7018@c FIXME: if the Chill Manual is a Texinfo documents, the above should
7019@c be converted to a @ref.
cce74817
JM
7020
7021@ignore
7022@itemize @bullet
7023@item
7024@emph{Integer Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
d4f3574e 7025programs (refer to the Chill Standard z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.2)
cce74817
JM
7026@item
7027@emph{Boolean Literals} are defined by @code{TRUE} and @code{FALSE}.
7028@item
7029@emph{Character Literals} are defined by @code{'<character>'}. (e.g.
7030@code{'M'})
7031@item
7032@emph{Set Literals} are defined by a name which was specified in a set
d4f3574e
SS
7033mode. The value delivered by a Set Literal is the set value. This is
7034comparable to an enumeration in C/C++ language.
cce74817 7035@item
d4f3574e 7036@emph{Emptiness Literal} is predefined by @code{NULL}. The value of the
cce74817
JM
7037emptiness literal delivers either the empty reference value, the empty
7038procedure value or the empty instance value.
7039
7040@item
7041@emph{Character String Literals} are defined by a sequence of characters
d4f3574e 7042enclosed in single- or double quotes. If a single- or double quote has
cce74817
JM
7043to be part of the string literal it has to be stuffed (specified twice).
7044@item
7045@emph{Bitstring Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
7046programs (refer z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.8).
7047@item
7048@emph{Floating point literals} are specified in the same manner as in
d4f3574e 7049(gnu-)Chill programs (refer @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual chapter 1.5).
cce74817
JM
7050@end itemize
7051@end ignore
7052
7053@item Tuple Values
7054A tuple is specified by @code{<mode name>[<tuple>]}, where @code{<mode
d4f3574e 7055name>} can be omitted if the mode of the tuple is unambiguous. This
cce74817
JM
7056unambiguity is derived from the context of a evaluated expression.
7057@code{<tuple>} can be one of the following:
d4f3574e 7058
cce74817
JM
7059@itemize @bullet
7060@item @emph{Powerset Tuple}
7061@item @emph{Array Tuple}
7062@item @emph{Structure Tuple}
7063Powerset tuples, array tuples and structure tuples are specified in the
d4f3574e 7064same manner as in Chill programs refer to z200/88 chpt 5.2.5.
cce74817
JM
7065@end itemize
7066
7067@item String Element Value
7068A string element value is specified by @code{<string value>(<index>)},
d4f3574e 7069where @code{<index>} is a integer expression. It delivers a character
cce74817
JM
7070value which is equivalent to the character indexed by @code{<index>} in
7071the string.
7072
7073@item String Slice Value
7074A string slice value is specified by @code{<string value>(<slice
7075spec>)}, where @code{<slice spec>} can be either a range of integer
7076expressions or specified by @code{<start expr> up <size>}.
7077@code{<size>} denotes the number of elements which the slice contains.
7078The delivered value is a string value, which is part of the specified
7079string.
7080
7081@item Array Element Values
7082An array element value is specified by @code{<array value>(<expr>)} and
7083delivers a array element value of the mode of the specified array.
7084
7085@item Array Slice Values
7086An array slice is specified by @code{<array value>(<slice spec>)}, where
7087@code{<slice spec>} can be either a range specified by expressions or by
d4f3574e
SS
7088@code{<start expr> up <size>}. @code{<size>} denotes the number of
7089arrayelements the slice contains. The delivered value is an array value
cce74817
JM
7090which is part of the specified array.
7091
7092@item Structure Field Values
7093A structure field value is derived by @code{<structure value>.<field
d4f3574e
SS
7094name>}, where @code{<field name>} indicates the name of a field specified
7095in the mode definition of the structure. The mode of the delivered value
cce74817
JM
7096corresponds to this mode definition in the structure definition.
7097
7098@item Procedure Call Value
7099The procedure call value is derived from the return value of the
7100procedure@footnote{If a procedure call is used for instance in an
7101expression, then this procedure is called with all its side
d4f3574e 7102effects. This can lead to confusing results if used carelessly.}.
cce74817 7103
d4f3574e 7104Values of duration mode locations are represented by @code{ULONG} literals.
cce74817 7105
d4f3574e 7106Values of time mode locations are represented by @code{TIME(<secs>:<nsecs>)}.
cce74817
JM
7107
7108@ignore
7109This is not implemented yet:
7110@item Built-in Value
7111@noindent
7112The following built in functions are provided:
d4f3574e 7113
cce74817
JM
7114@table @code
7115@item @code{ADDR()}
7116@item @code{NUM()}
7117@item @code{PRED()}
7118@item @code{SUCC()}
7119@item @code{ABS()}
7120@item @code{CARD()}
7121@item @code{MAX()}
7122@item @code{MIN()}
7123@item @code{SIZE()}
7124@item @code{UPPER()}
7125@item @code{LOWER()}
7126@item @code{LENGTH()}
7127@item @code{SIN()}
7128@item @code{COS()}
7129@item @code{TAN()}
7130@item @code{ARCSIN()}
7131@item @code{ARCCOS()}
7132@item @code{ARCTAN()}
7133@item @code{EXP()}
7134@item @code{LN()}
7135@item @code{LOG()}
7136@item @code{SQRT()}
7137@end table
7138
7139For a detailed description refer to the GNU Chill implementation manual
7140chapter 1.6.
7141@end ignore
7142
7143@item Zero-adic Operator Value
7144The zero-adic operator value is derived from the instance value for the
7145current active process.
7146
7147@item Expression Values
7148The value delivered by an expression is the result of the evaluation of
d4f3574e 7149the specified expression. If there are error conditions (mode
cce74817 7150incompatibility, etc.) the evaluation of expressions is aborted with a
d4f3574e 7151corresponding error message. Expressions may be parenthesised which
cce74817 7152causes the evaluation of this expression before any other expression
d4f3574e 7153which uses the result of the parenthesised expression. The following
cce74817 7154operators are supported by @value{GDBN}:
d4f3574e 7155
cce74817
JM
7156@table @code
7157@item @code{OR, ORIF, XOR}
d4f3574e
SS
7158@itemx @code{AND, ANDIF}
7159@itemx @code{NOT}
cce74817 7160Logical operators defined over operands of boolean mode.
d4f3574e 7161
cce74817
JM
7162@item @code{=, /=}
7163Equality and inequality operators defined over all modes.
d4f3574e 7164
cce74817 7165@item @code{>, >=}
d4f3574e 7166@itemx @code{<, <=}
cce74817 7167Relational operators defined over predefined modes.
d4f3574e 7168
cce74817 7169@item @code{+, -}
d4f3574e 7170@itemx @code{*, /, MOD, REM}
cce74817 7171Arithmetic operators defined over predefined modes.
d4f3574e 7172
cce74817
JM
7173@item @code{-}
7174Change sign operator.
d4f3574e 7175
cce74817
JM
7176@item @code{//}
7177String concatenation operator.
d4f3574e 7178
cce74817
JM
7179@item @code{()}
7180String repetition operator.
d4f3574e 7181
cce74817
JM
7182@item @code{->}
7183Referenced location operator which can be used either to take the
7184address of a location (@code{->loc}), or to dereference a reference
7185location (@code{loc->}).
d4f3574e 7186
cce74817 7187@item @code{OR, XOR}
d4f3574e
SS
7188@itemx @code{AND}
7189@itemx @code{NOT}
cce74817 7190Powerset and bitstring operators.
d4f3574e 7191
cce74817 7192@item @code{>, >=}
d4f3574e 7193@itemx @code{<, <=}
cce74817 7194Powerset inclusion operators.
d4f3574e 7195
cce74817
JM
7196@item @code{IN}
7197Membership operator.
7198@end table
7199@end table
7200
53a5351d 7201@node Chill type and range checks
cce74817
JM
7202@subsubsection Chill type and range checks
7203
7204@value{GDBN} considers two Chill variables mode equivalent if the sizes
d4f3574e 7205of the two modes are equal. This rule applies recursively to more
cce74817 7206complex datatypes which means that complex modes are treated
d4f3574e 7207equivalent if all element modes (which also can be complex modes like
cce74817
JM
7208structures, arrays, etc.) have the same size.
7209
7210Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
7211index bounds and all built in procedures.
7212
7213Strong type checks are forced using the @value{GDBN} command @code{set
d4f3574e 7214check strong}. This enforces strong type and range checks on all
cce74817
JM
7215operations where Chill constructs are used (expressions, built in
7216functions, etc.) in respect to the semantics as defined in the z.200
7217language specification.
7218
cce74817
JM
7219All checks can be disabled by the @value{GDBN} command @code{set check
7220off}.
7221
7222@ignore
53a5351d 7223@c Deviations from the Chill Standard Z200/88
cce74817
JM
7224see last paragraph ?
7225@end ignore
7226
53a5351d 7227@node Chill defaults
cce74817
JM
7228@subsubsection Chill defaults
7229
7230If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
7231both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
d4f3574e 7232Chill. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
cce74817
JM
7233selected the working language.
7234
7235If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
7236code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.ch} sets the
d4f3574e 7237working language to Chill. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
cce74817
JM
7238the language automatically}, for further details.
7239
53a5351d 7240@node Symbols
c906108c
SS
7241@chapter Examining the Symbol Table
7242
d4f3574e 7243The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
c906108c
SS
7244symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
7245program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
7246does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
7247program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
7248(@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing files}), or by one of the
7249file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
7250
7251@cindex symbol names
7252@cindex names of symbols
7253@cindex quoting names
7254Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
7255characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
7256most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
7257source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program variables}). File names
7258are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
7259ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
7260@samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
7261@samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
7262
7263@example
7264p 'foo.c'::x
7265@end example
7266
7267@noindent
7268looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
7269
7270@table @code
7271@kindex info address
7272@item info address @var{symbol}
7273Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
7274variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
7275local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
7276is always stored.
7277
7278Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
7279at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
7280the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
7281
7282@kindex whatis
d4f3574e
SS
7283@item whatis @var{expr}
7284Print the data type of expression @var{expr}. @var{expr} is not
c906108c
SS
7285actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
7286assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
7287@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
7288
7289@item whatis
7290Print the data type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
7291
7292@kindex ptype
7293@item ptype @var{typename}
7294Print a description of data type @var{typename}. @var{typename} may be
7a292a7a
SS
7295the name of a type, or for C code it may have the form @samp{class
7296@var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
7297@var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
c906108c 7298
d4f3574e 7299@item ptype @var{expr}
c906108c 7300@itemx ptype
d4f3574e 7301Print a description of the type of expression @var{expr}. @code{ptype}
c906108c
SS
7302differs from @code{whatis} by printing a detailed description, instead
7303of just the name of the type.
7304
7305For example, for this variable declaration:
7306
7307@example
7308struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
7309@end example
7310
7311@noindent
7312the two commands give this output:
7313
7314@example
7315@group
7316(@value{GDBP}) whatis v
7317type = struct complex
7318(@value{GDBP}) ptype v
7319type = struct complex @{
7320 double real;
7321 double imag;
7322@}
7323@end group
7324@end example
7325
7326@noindent
7327As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
7328the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
7329
7330@kindex info types
7331@item info types @var{regexp}
7332@itemx info types
d4f3574e 7333Print a brief description of all types whose names match @var{regexp}
c906108c
SS
7334(or all types in your program, if you supply no argument). Each
7335complete typename is matched as though it were a complete line; thus,
7336@samp{i type value} gives information on all types in your program whose
d4f3574e 7337names include the string @code{value}, but @samp{i type ^value$} gives
c906108c
SS
7338information only on types whose complete name is @code{value}.
7339
7340This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
7341@code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
7342lists all source files where a type is defined.
7343
7344@kindex info source
7345@item info source
7346Show the name of the current source file---that is, the source file for
7347the function containing the current point of execution---and the language
7348it was written in.
7349
7350@kindex info sources
7351@item info sources
7352Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
7353debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
7354have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
7355
7356@kindex info functions
7357@item info functions
7358Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
7359
7360@item info functions @var{regexp}
7361Print the names and data types of all defined functions
7362whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
7363Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
7364include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
7365start with @code{step}.
7366
7367@kindex info variables
7368@item info variables
7369Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
7370outside of functions (i.e., excluding local variables).
7371
7372@item info variables @var{regexp}
7373Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
7374variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
7375@var{regexp}.
7376
7377@ignore
7378This was never implemented.
7379@kindex info methods
7380@item info methods
7381@itemx info methods @var{regexp}
7382The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
7383methods within C++ program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
7384specific set of methods found in the various C++ classes. Many
7385C++ classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
7386from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
7387@code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
7388which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
7389@end ignore
7390
c906108c
SS
7391@cindex reloading symbols
7392Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
7a292a7a
SS
7393be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
7394in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
7395running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
7396@value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
c906108c
SS
7397
7398@table @code
7399@kindex set symbol-reloading
7400@item set symbol-reloading on
7401Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
7402object file with a particular name is seen again.
7403
7404@item set symbol-reloading off
7405Do not replace symbol definitions when re-encountering object files of
7406the same name. This is the default state; if you are not running on a
7407system that permits automatically relinking modules, you should leave
7408@code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN} may discard symbols
7409when linking large programs, that may contain several modules (from
7410different directories or libraries) with the same name.
7411
7412@kindex show symbol-reloading
7413@item show symbol-reloading
7414Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
7415@end table
c906108c 7416
c906108c
SS
7417@kindex set opaque-type-resolution
7418@item set opaque-type-resolution on
7419Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
7420declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
7421@code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
7422source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
7423another source file. The default is on.
7424
7425A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
7426the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
7427
7428@item set opaque-type-resolution off
7429Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
7430is printed as follows:
7431@smallexample
7432@{<no data fields>@}
7433@end smallexample
7434
7435@kindex show opaque-type-resolution
7436@item show opaque-type-resolution
7437Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
c906108c
SS
7438
7439@kindex maint print symbols
7440@cindex symbol dump
7441@kindex maint print psymbols
7442@cindex partial symbol dump
7443@item maint print symbols @var{filename}
7444@itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
7445@itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
7446Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
7447These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
7448symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
7449symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
7450collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
7451only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
7452command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
7453use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
7454symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
7455files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
7456@samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
7457required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
7458@xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}, for a discussion of how
7459@value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
7460@end table
7461
53a5351d 7462@node Altering
c906108c
SS
7463@chapter Altering Execution
7464
7465Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
7466find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
7467correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
7468experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
7469program.
7470
7471For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
7a292a7a
SS
7472locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
7473address, or even return prematurely from a function.
c906108c
SS
7474
7475@menu
7476* Assignment:: Assignment to variables
7477* Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
c906108c 7478* Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
c906108c
SS
7479* Returning:: Returning from a function
7480* Calling:: Calling your program's functions
7481* Patching:: Patching your program
7482@end menu
7483
53a5351d 7484@node Assignment
c906108c
SS
7485@section Assignment to variables
7486
7487@cindex assignment
7488@cindex setting variables
7489To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
7490@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
7491
7492@example
7493print x=4
7494@end example
7495
7496@noindent
7497stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
7498value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
c906108c
SS
7499@xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
7500information on operators in supported languages.
c906108c
SS
7501
7502@kindex set variable
7503@cindex variables, setting
7504If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
7505@code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
7506really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
7507not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
7508,Value history}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
7509
c906108c
SS
7510If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
7511appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
7512variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
7513to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
7514program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
7515a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
7516command @code{set width}:
7517
7518@example
7519(@value{GDBP}) whatis width
7520type = double
7521(@value{GDBP}) p width
7522$4 = 13
7523(@value{GDBP}) set width=47
7524Invalid syntax in expression.
7525@end example
7526
7527@noindent
7528The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
7529order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
7530
7531@example
7532(@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
7533@end example
53a5351d 7534
c906108c
SS
7535Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
7536with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
7537@code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
7538your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
7539to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
7540the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
7541
7542@example
7543@group
7544(@value{GDBP}) whatis g
7545type = double
7546(@value{GDBP}) p g
7547$1 = 1
7548(@value{GDBP}) set g=4
2df3850c 7549(@value{GDBP}) p g
c906108c
SS
7550$2 = 1
7551(@value{GDBP}) r
7552The program being debugged has been started already.
7553Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
7554Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
7555"/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols: Invalid bfd target.
7556(@value{GDBP}) show g
7557The current BFD target is "=4".
7558@end group
7559@end example
7560
7561@noindent
7562The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
7563@code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
7564@code{g}, use
7565
7566@example
7567(@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
7568@end example
c906108c
SS
7569
7570@value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
7571freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
7572and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
7573same length or shorter.
7574@comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
7575@comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
7576
7577To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
7578construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
7579(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
7580to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
7581and representation in memory), and
7582
7583@example
7584set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
7585@end example
7586
7587@noindent
7588stores the value 4 into that memory location.
7589
53a5351d 7590@node Jumping
c906108c
SS
7591@section Continuing at a different address
7592
7593Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
7594it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
7595an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
7596
7597@table @code
7598@kindex jump
7599@item jump @var{linespec}
7600Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
7601immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
7602source lines}, for a description of the different forms of
7603@var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
7604in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
7605breakpoints}.
7606
7607The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
7608the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
7609register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
7610a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
7611be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
7612of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
7613confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
7614executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
7615well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
7616
7617@item jump *@var{address}
7618Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
7619@end table
7620
c906108c 7621@c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
53a5351d
JM
7622On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
7623command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
7624difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
7625changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
7626example,
c906108c
SS
7627
7628@example
7629set $pc = 0x485
7630@end example
7631
7632@noindent
7633makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
7634address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
7635@xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}.
c906108c
SS
7636
7637The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
7638up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
7639that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
7640detail.
7641
c906108c 7642@c @group
53a5351d 7643@node Signaling
c906108c
SS
7644@section Giving your program a signal
7645
7646@table @code
7647@kindex signal
7648@item signal @var{signal}
7649Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
7650signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
7651signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
7652SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
7653
7654Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
7655giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
7656a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
7657@code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
7658signal.
7659
7660@code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
7661after executing the command.
7662@end table
7663@c @end group
7664
7665Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
7666@code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
7667causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
7668the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
7669passes the signal directly to your program.
7670
c906108c 7671
53a5351d 7672@node Returning
c906108c
SS
7673@section Returning from a function
7674
7675@table @code
7676@cindex returning from a function
7677@kindex return
7678@item return
7679@itemx return @var{expression}
7680You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
7681command. If you give an
7682@var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
7683value.
7684@end table
7685
7686When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
7687(and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
7688discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
7689be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
7690
7691This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
7692frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
7693innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
7694specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
7695of functions.
7696
7697The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
7698program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
7699returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
7700and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}) resumes execution until the
7701selected stack frame returns naturally.
7702
53a5351d 7703@node Calling
c906108c
SS
7704@section Calling program functions
7705
7706@cindex calling functions
7707@kindex call
7708@table @code
7709@item call @var{expr}
7710Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
7711returned values.
7712@end table
7713
7714You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
7715execute a function from your program, but without cluttering the output
7716with @code{void} returned values. If the result is not void, it
7717is printed and saved in the value history.
7718
c906108c
SS
7719For the A29K, a user-controlled variable @code{call_scratch_address},
7720specifies the location of a scratch area to be used when @value{GDBN}
7721calls a function in the target. This is necessary because the usual
7722method of putting the scratch area on the stack does not work in systems
7723that have separate instruction and data spaces.
c906108c 7724
53a5351d 7725@node Patching
c906108c 7726@section Patching programs
7a292a7a 7727
c906108c
SS
7728@cindex patching binaries
7729@cindex writing into executables
c906108c 7730@cindex writing into corefiles
c906108c 7731
7a292a7a
SS
7732By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
7733executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
7734alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
7735patching your program's binary.
c906108c
SS
7736
7737If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
7738explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
7739want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
7740repairs.
7741
7742@table @code
7743@kindex set write
7744@item set write on
7745@itemx set write off
7a292a7a
SS
7746If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
7747core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
c906108c
SS
7748off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
7749
7750If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
7a292a7a
SS
7751@code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
7752write}, for your new setting to take effect.
c906108c
SS
7753
7754@item show write
7755@kindex show write
7a292a7a
SS
7756Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
7757as well as reading.
c906108c
SS
7758@end table
7759
53a5351d 7760@node GDB Files
c906108c
SS
7761@chapter @value{GDBN} Files
7762
7a292a7a
SS
7763@value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
7764both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
7765program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
7766@value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
c906108c
SS
7767
7768@menu
7769* Files:: Commands to specify files
7770* Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
7771@end menu
7772
53a5351d 7773@node Files
c906108c 7774@section Commands to specify files
c906108c 7775
7a292a7a 7776@cindex symbol table
c906108c 7777@cindex core dump file
7a292a7a
SS
7778
7779You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
7780way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
7781@value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
7782Out of @value{GDBN}}).
c906108c
SS
7783
7784Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
7785@value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to specify
7786a file you want to use. In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands
7787to specify new files are useful.
7788
7789@table @code
7790@cindex executable file
7791@kindex file
7792@item file @var{filename}
7793Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
7794symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
7795executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
7796directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
7797@value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
7798directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
7799to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
7800and your program, using the @code{path} command.
7801
c906108c
SS
7802On systems with memory-mapped files, an auxiliary file
7803@file{@var{filename}.syms} may hold symbol table information for
7804@var{filename}. If so, @value{GDBN} maps in the symbol table from
7805@file{@var{filename}.syms}, starting up more quickly. See the
7806descriptions of the file options @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow}
7807(available on the command line, and with the commands @code{file},
7808@code{symbol-file}, or @code{add-symbol-file}, described below),
7809for more information.
c906108c
SS
7810
7811@item file
7812@code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
7813has on both executable file and the symbol table.
7814
7815@kindex exec-file
7816@item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
7817Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
7818in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
7819if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
7820discard information on the executable file.
7821
7822@kindex symbol-file
7823@item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
7824Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
7825searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
7826table and program to run from the same file.
7827
7828@code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
7829program's symbol table.
7830
7831The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents
7832of its convenience variables, the value history, and all breakpoints and
7833auto-display expressions. This is because they may contain pointers to
7834the internal data recording symbols and data types, which are part of
7835the old symbol table data being discarded inside @value{GDBN}.
7836
7837@code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
7838executing it once.
7839
7840When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
7841understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
7842generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
7843other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
c906108c
SS
7844Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
7845using @code{@value{GCC}} you can generate debugging information for
7846optimized code.
c906108c
SS
7847
7848For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
7849using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
7850symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
7851quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
7852details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
7853
7854The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
7855start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
7856occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
7857file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
7858pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
7859warnings and messages}.)
7860
c906108c
SS
7861We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
7862symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
7863symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
7864still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
7865in stabs format.
7866
7867@kindex readnow
7868@cindex reading symbols immediately
7869@cindex symbols, reading immediately
7870@kindex mapped
7871@cindex memory-mapped symbol file
7872@cindex saving symbol table
7873@item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
7874@itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
7875You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
7876tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
7877load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
7878entire symbol table available.
c906108c 7879
c906108c
SS
7880If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the
7881@code{mmap} system call, you can use another option, @samp{-mapped}, to
7882cause @value{GDBN} to write the symbols for your program into a reusable
7883file. Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions map in symbol information
7884from this auxiliary symbol file (if the program has not changed), rather
7885than spending time reading the symbol table from the executable
7886program. Using the @samp{-mapped} option has the same effect as
7887starting @value{GDBN} with the @samp{-mapped} command-line option.
7888
7889You can use both options together, to make sure the auxiliary symbol
7890file has all the symbol information for your program.
7891
7892The auxiliary symbol file for a program called @var{myprog} is called
7893@samp{@var{myprog}.syms}. Once this file exists (so long as it is newer
7894than the corresponding executable), @value{GDBN} always attempts to use
7895it when you debug @var{myprog}; no special options or commands are
7896needed.
7897
7898The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where you run
7899@value{GDBN}. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN}
7900symbol table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c
SS
7901
7902@c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
7903@c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
7904@c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
7905@c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
7906@c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
7907@c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
7908@c files.
7909
7910@kindex core
7911@kindex core-file
7912@item core-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
7913Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
7914of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
7915address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
7916executable file itself for other parts.
7917
7918@code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
7919to be used.
7920
7921Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
7a292a7a
SS
7922under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
7923wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
7924the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
c906108c 7925(@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the child process}).
c906108c 7926
c906108c
SS
7927@kindex add-symbol-file
7928@cindex dynamic linking
7929@item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
7930@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
2acceee2
JM
7931@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @var{data_address} @var{bss_address}
7932@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-T}@var{section} @var{address}
96a2c332
SS
7933The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
7934information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
7935when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
7936into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
7937address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
7938this out for itself. You can specify up to three addresses, in which
7939case they are taken to be the addresses of the text, data, and bss
7940segments respectively. For complicated cases, you can specify an
7941arbitrary number of @samp{@r{-T}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to
7942give an explicit section name and base address for that section. You
7943can specify any @var{address} as an expression.
c906108c
SS
7944
7945The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
7946originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
96a2c332
SS
7947@code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
7948thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
7949instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
c906108c
SS
7950
7951@code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
7952
7953You can use the @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow} options just as with
7954the @code{symbol-file} command, to change how @value{GDBN} manages the symbol
7955table information for @var{filename}.
7956
7957@kindex add-shared-symbol-file
7958@item add-shared-symbol-file
7959The @code{add-shared-symbol-file} command can be used only under Harris' CXUX
7960operating system for the Motorola 88k. @value{GDBN} automatically looks for
7961shared libraries, however if @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can run
7962@code{add-shared-symbol-file}. It takes no arguments.
c906108c 7963
c906108c
SS
7964@kindex section
7965@item section
7966The @code{section} command changes the base address of section SECTION of
7967the exec file to ADDR. This can be used if the exec file does not contain
7968section addresses, (such as in the a.out format), or when the addresses
7969specified in the file itself are wrong. Each section must be changed
d4f3574e
SS
7970separately. The @code{info files} command, described below, lists all
7971the sections and their addresses.
c906108c
SS
7972
7973@kindex info files
7974@kindex info target
7975@item info files
7976@itemx info target
7a292a7a
SS
7977@code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
7978current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
7979including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
7980use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
7981command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
7982current ones.
7983
c906108c
SS
7984@end table
7985
7986All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
7987as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
7988name and remembers it that way.
7989
c906108c 7990@cindex shared libraries
c906108c
SS
7991@value{GDBN} supports HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix 5, and IBM RS/6000 shared
7992libraries.
53a5351d 7993
c906108c
SS
7994@value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
7995when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
7996(Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
7997references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
7998debugging a core file).
53a5351d
JM
7999
8000On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
8001automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
8002
c906108c
SS
8003@c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
8004@c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
8005@c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
8006
8007@table @code
8008@kindex info sharedlibrary
8009@kindex info share
8010@item info share
8011@itemx info sharedlibrary
8012Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
8013
8014@kindex sharedlibrary
8015@kindex share
8016@item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
8017@itemx share @var{regex}
c906108c
SS
8018Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
8019Unix regular expression.
8020As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
8021required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
8022@var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
8023loaded.
8024@end table
8025
53a5351d
JM
8026On HP-UX systems, @value{GDBN} detects the loading of a shared library
8027and automatically reads in symbols from the newly loaded library, up to
8028a threshold that is initially set but that you can modify if you wish.
c906108c
SS
8029
8030Beyond that threshold, symbols from shared libraries must be explicitly
d4f3574e
SS
8031loaded. To load these symbols, use the command @code{sharedlibrary
8032@var{filename}}. The base address of the shared library is determined
c906108c
SS
8033automatically by @value{GDBN} and need not be specified.
8034
8035To display or set the threshold, use the commands:
8036
8037@table @code
8038@kindex set auto-solib-add
8039@item set auto-solib-add @var{threshold}
8040Set the autoloading size threshold, in megabytes. If @var{threshold} is
8041nonzero, symbols from all shared object libraries will be loaded
8042automatically when the inferior begins execution or when the dynamic
8043linker informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded, until
8044the symbol table of the program and libraries exceeds this threshold.
8045Otherwise, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
8046@code{sharedlibrary} command. The default threshold is 100 megabytes.
8047
8048@kindex show auto-solib-add
8049@item show auto-solib-add
8050Display the current autoloading size threshold, in megabytes.
8051@end table
c906108c 8052
53a5351d 8053@node Symbol Errors
c906108c
SS
8054@section Errors reading symbol files
8055
8056While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
8057such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
8058output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
8059they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
8060debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
8061about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
8062only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
8063times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
8064to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
8065complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
8066messages}).
8067
8068The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
8069
8070@table @code
8071@item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
8072
8073The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
8074(such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
8075error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
8076in its outer scope blocks.
8077
8078@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
8079the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
8080may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
8081function.
8082
8083@item block at @var{address} out of order
8084
8085The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
8086order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
8087do so.
8088
8089@value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
8090locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
8091can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
8092@code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
8093messages}.)
8094
8095@item bad block start address patched
8096
8097The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
8098smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
8099to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
8100
8101@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
8102starting on the previous source line.
8103
8104@item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
8105
8106@cindex foo
8107Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
8108larger than the size of the string table.
8109
8110@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
8111name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
8112with this name.
8113
8114@item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
8115
7a292a7a
SS
8116The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
8117not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
d4f3574e 8118uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
c906108c 8119
7a292a7a
SS
8120@value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
8121This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
c906108c 8122are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
7a292a7a
SS
8123debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
8124on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
8125and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
c906108c
SS
8126
8127@item stub type has NULL name
c906108c 8128
7a292a7a 8129@value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
c906108c 8130
7a292a7a 8131@item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
c906108c 8132The symbol information for a C++ member function is missing some
7a292a7a
SS
8133information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
8134it.
c906108c
SS
8135
8136@item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
8137
8138@value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
7a292a7a 8139
c906108c
SS
8140@end table
8141
53a5351d 8142@node Targets
c906108c 8143@chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
7a292a7a 8144
c906108c
SS
8145@cindex debugging target
8146@kindex target
8147
8148A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
53a5351d
JM
8149
8150Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
8151in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
8152you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
c906108c
SS
8153flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
8154host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
53a5351d
JM
8155realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
8156command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
8157(@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
c906108c
SS
8158
8159@menu
8160* Active Targets:: Active targets
8161* Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
c906108c
SS
8162* Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
8163* Remote:: Remote debugging
96baa820 8164* KOD:: Kernel Object Display
c906108c
SS
8165
8166@end menu
8167
53a5351d 8168@node Active Targets
c906108c 8169@section Active targets
7a292a7a 8170
c906108c
SS
8171@cindex stacking targets
8172@cindex active targets
8173@cindex multiple targets
8174
c906108c 8175There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
7a292a7a
SS
8176executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
8177active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
8178start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
8179a core file.
c906108c
SS
8180
8181For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
8182@code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
8183well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
8184@value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
8185first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
8186requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
8187are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
8188read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
8189executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
c906108c
SS
8190
8191When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
7a292a7a
SS
8192target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
8193commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
8194an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
8195process target is active.
c906108c 8196
7a292a7a
SS
8197Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
8198core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify
c906108c 8199files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
7a292a7a
SS
8200the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running
8201process}).
c906108c 8202
53a5351d 8203@node Target Commands
c906108c
SS
8204@section Commands for managing targets
8205
8206@table @code
8207@item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
7a292a7a
SS
8208Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
8209process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
8210facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
8211protocol of the target machine.
c906108c
SS
8212
8213Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
8214typically include things like device names or host names to connect
8215with, process numbers, and baud rates.
c906108c
SS
8216
8217The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
8218after executing the command.
8219
8220@kindex help target
8221@item help target
8222Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
8223currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
8224(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
8225
8226@item help target @var{name}
8227Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
8228select it.
8229
8230@kindex set gnutarget
8231@item set gnutarget @var{args}
8232@value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
8233knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
8234a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
8235with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
8236with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
8237
d4f3574e 8238@quotation
c906108c
SS
8239@emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
8240you must know the actual BFD name.
d4f3574e 8241@end quotation
c906108c 8242
d4f3574e
SS
8243@noindent
8244@xref{Files, , Commands to specify files}.
c906108c
SS
8245
8246@kindex show gnutarget
8247@item show gnutarget
8248Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
8249@code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
8250@value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
8251and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
8252@end table
8253
c906108c
SS
8254Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
8255configuration):
c906108c
SS
8256
8257@table @code
8258@kindex target exec
8259@item target exec @var{program}
8260An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
8261@samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
8262
c906108c
SS
8263@kindex target core
8264@item target core @var{filename}
8265A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
8266@samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
c906108c
SS
8267
8268@kindex target remote
8269@item target remote @var{dev}
8270Remote serial target in GDB-specific protocol. The argument @var{dev}
8271specifies what serial device to use for the connection (e.g.
8272@file{/dev/ttya}). @xref{Remote, ,Remote debugging}. @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 8273supports the @code{load} command. This is only useful if you have
c906108c
SS
8274some other way of getting the stub to the target system, and you can put
8275it somewhere in memory where it won't get clobbered by the download.
8276
c906108c
SS
8277@kindex target sim
8278@item target sim
2df3850c 8279Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
104c1213
JM
8280In general,
8281@example
8282 target sim
8283 load
8284 run
8285@end example
d4f3574e 8286@noindent
104c1213 8287works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
d4f3574e 8288drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
104c1213
JM
8289provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
8290see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
8291Processors}.
8292
c906108c
SS
8293@end table
8294
104c1213 8295Some configurations may include these targets as well:
c906108c
SS
8296
8297@table @code
8298
c906108c
SS
8299@kindex target nrom
8300@item target nrom @var{dev}
8301NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
8302
c906108c
SS
8303@end table
8304
c906108c
SS
8305Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
8306your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
c906108c
SS
8307
8308Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code
8309once you've successfully established a connection.
8310
8311@table @code
8312
8313@kindex load @var{filename}
8314@item load @var{filename}
c906108c
SS
8315Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
8316@value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
8317is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
8318on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
8319@code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
8320the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
8321
8322If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
8323execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
8324target is @dots{}}''
c906108c
SS
8325
8326The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
8327For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
8328link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
8329specifies a fixed address.
8330@c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
8331
c906108c
SS
8332@code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
8333@end table
8334
53a5351d 8335@node Byte Order
c906108c 8336@section Choosing target byte order
7a292a7a 8337
c906108c
SS
8338@cindex choosing target byte order
8339@cindex target byte order
8340@kindex set endian big
8341@kindex set endian little
8342@kindex set endian auto
8343@kindex show endian
8344
8345Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Hitachi SH,
8346offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
8347orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
8348designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
8349which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
d4f3574e 8350@value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
c906108c
SS
8351
8352@table @code
8353@kindex set endian big
8354@item set endian big
8355Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
8356
8357@kindex set endian little
8358@item set endian little
8359Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
8360
8361@kindex set endian auto
8362@item set endian auto
8363Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
8364executable.
8365
8366@item show endian
8367Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
8368
8369@end table
8370
8371Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
8372data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
8373target system.
8374
53a5351d 8375@node Remote
c906108c
SS
8376@section Remote debugging
8377@cindex remote debugging
8378
8379If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
8380@value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
8381For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
8382or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
8383powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
8384
8385Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
8386to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
8387@value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
8388but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
8389write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
8390communicate with @value{GDBN}.
8391
8392Other remote targets may be available in your
8393configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
c906108c 8394
c906108c 8395@menu
c906108c 8396* Remote Serial:: @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol
c906108c
SS
8397@end menu
8398
104c1213
JM
8399@node Remote Serial
8400@subsection The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol
7a292a7a 8401
104c1213
JM
8402@cindex remote serial debugging, overview
8403To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
8404@dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
8405prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
8406program, you need:
c906108c 8407
104c1213
JM
8408@enumerate
8409@item
8410A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
8411have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
8412your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
96baa820 8413
104c1213 8414@item
d4f3574e 8415A C subroutine library to support your program's
104c1213 8416subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
96baa820 8417
104c1213
JM
8418@item
8419A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
8420download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
8421manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
8422documentation.
8423@end enumerate
96baa820 8424
104c1213
JM
8425The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
8426communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
8427machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
96baa820 8428
104c1213
JM
8429@table @emph
8430@item On the host,
8431@value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
8432else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
8433(@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
8434
8435@item On the target,
8436you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
8437implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
8438subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
8439
8440On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
8441@code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
8442@xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} program}, for details.
8443@end table
96baa820 8444
104c1213
JM
8445The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
8446machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
8447@sc{sparc} boards.
96baa820 8448
104c1213
JM
8449@cindex remote serial stub list
8450These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
96baa820 8451
104c1213
JM
8452@table @code
8453
8454@item i386-stub.c
8455@kindex i386-stub.c
8456@cindex Intel
8457@cindex i386
8458For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
8459
8460@item m68k-stub.c
8461@kindex m68k-stub.c
8462@cindex Motorola 680x0
8463@cindex m680x0
8464For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
8465
8466@item sh-stub.c
8467@kindex sh-stub.c
8468@cindex Hitachi
8469@cindex SH
8470For Hitachi SH architectures.
8471
8472@item sparc-stub.c
8473@kindex sparc-stub.c
8474@cindex Sparc
8475For @sc{sparc} architectures.
8476
8477@item sparcl-stub.c
8478@kindex sparcl-stub.c
8479@cindex Fujitsu
8480@cindex SparcLite
8481For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
8482
8483@end table
8484
8485The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
8486recently added stubs.
8487
8488@menu
8489* Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
8490* Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
8491* Debug Session:: Putting it all together
8492* Protocol:: Definition of the communication protocol
8493* Server:: Using the `gdbserver' program
8494* NetWare:: Using the `gdbserve.nlm' program
8495@end menu
8496
8497@node Stub Contents
8498@subsubsection What the stub can do for you
8499
8500@cindex remote serial stub
8501The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
8502subroutines:
8503
8504@table @code
8505@item set_debug_traps
8506@kindex set_debug_traps
8507@cindex remote serial stub, initialization
8508This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
8509program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
8510beginning of your program.
8511
8512@item handle_exception
8513@kindex handle_exception
8514@cindex remote serial stub, main routine
8515This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
8516explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
8517run when a trap is triggered.
8518
8519@code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
8520execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
8521with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
8522protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
d4f3574e 8523representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
104c1213
JM
8524information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
8525retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
8526execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
8527@code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
8528machine.
8529
8530@item breakpoint
8531@cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
8532Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
8533breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
8534way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
8535machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
8536pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
8537@code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
8538simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
8539again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
8540your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
8541@value{GDBN} session gets control.
8542
8543Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
8544to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
8545start of your debugging session.
8546@end table
8547
8548@node Bootstrapping
8549@subsubsection What you must do for the stub
8550
8551@cindex remote stub, support routines
8552The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
8553chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
8554debugging target machine.
8555
8556First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
8557serial port.
8558
8559@table @code
8560@item int getDebugChar()
8561@kindex getDebugChar
8562Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
8563It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
8564different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
8565
8566@item void putDebugChar(int)
8567@kindex putDebugChar
8568Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
8569It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
8570different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
8571@end table
8572
8573@cindex control C, and remote debugging
8574@cindex interrupting remote targets
8575If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
8576running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
8577for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
8578character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
8579remote system to stop.
8580
8581Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
8582probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
8583is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
8584@value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
8585
8586Other routines you need to supply are:
8587
8588@table @code
8589@item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
8590@kindex exceptionHandler
8591Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
8592handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
8593way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
8594are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
8595containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
8596@var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
8597its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
8598might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
8599exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
8600@var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
8601and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
8602you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
8603should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
8604
8605For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
8606gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
8607should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
8608@sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
8609help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
8610
8611@item void flush_i_cache()
8612@kindex flush_i_cache
d4f3574e 8613On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
104c1213
JM
8614instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
8615instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
8616
8617On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
8618function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
8619@end table
8620
8621@noindent
8622You must also make sure this library routine is available:
8623
8624@table @code
8625@item void *memset(void *, int, int)
8626@kindex memset
8627This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
8628memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
8629@code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
8630either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
8631@end table
8632
8633If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
8634library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
8635but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
d4f3574e 8636subroutines which @code{@value{GCC}} generates as inline code.
104c1213
JM
8637
8638
8639@node Debug Session
8640@subsubsection Putting it all together
8641
8642@cindex remote serial debugging summary
8643In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
8644steps.
8645
8646@enumerate
8647@item
8648Make sure you have the supporting low-level routines
8649(@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What you must do for the stub}):
8650@display
8651@code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
8652@code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
8653@end display
8654
8655@item
8656Insert these lines near the top of your program:
8657
8658@example
8659set_debug_traps();
8660breakpoint();
8661@end example
8662
8663@item
8664For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
8665@code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
8666
8667@example
8668void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
8669@end example
8670
d4f3574e 8671@noindent
104c1213 8672but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
d4f3574e 8673function in your program; that function is called when
104c1213
JM
8674@code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
8675error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
8676one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
8677
8678@item
8679Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
8680your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
8681
8682@item
8683Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
8684the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
8685
8686@item
8687@c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
8688@c document that. FIXME.
8689Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
8690whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
8691
8692@item
8693To start remote debugging, run @value{GDBN} on the host machine, and specify
8694as an executable file the program that is running in the remote machine.
8695This tells @value{GDBN} how to find your program's symbols and the contents
8696of its pure text.
8697
d4f3574e 8698@item
104c1213 8699@cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 8700Establish communication using the @code{target remote} command.
104c1213
JM
8701Its argument specifies how to communicate with the target
8702machine---either via a devicename attached to a direct serial line, or a
8703TCP port (usually to a terminal server which in turn has a serial line
8704to the target). For example, to use a serial line connected to the
8705device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
8706
8707@example
8708target remote /dev/ttyb
8709@end example
8710
8711@cindex TCP port, @code{target remote}
8712To use a TCP connection, use an argument of the form
8713@code{@var{host}:port}. For example, to connect to port 2828 on a
8714terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
8715
8716@example
8717target remote manyfarms:2828
8718@end example
8719@end enumerate
8720
8721Now you can use all the usual commands to examine and change data and to
8722step and continue the remote program.
8723
8724To resume the remote program and stop debugging it, use the @code{detach}
8725command.
8726
8727@cindex interrupting remote programs
8728@cindex remote programs, interrupting
8729Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
8730interrupt character (often @key{C-C}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
8731program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
8732and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
8733interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
8734
8735@example
8736Interrupted while waiting for the program.
8737Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
8738@end example
8739
8740If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
8741(If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
8742remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
8743goes back to waiting.
8744
8745@node Protocol
8746@subsubsection Communication protocol
8747
8748@cindex debugging stub, example
8749@cindex remote stub, example
8750@cindex stub example, remote debugging
8751The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
8752communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
8753@value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
8754these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
8755implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
8756with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
8757organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
8758
8759However, there may be occasions when you need to know something about
8760the protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your
8761target machine, you might want your program to do something special if
8762it recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
8763
8764In the examples below, @samp{<-} and @samp{->} are used to indicate
8765transmitted and received data respectfully.
8766
8767@cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
8768@cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
8769@cindex remote serial protocol
8770All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments)
8771are sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the
8772character @samp{$}, this is followed by an optional two-digit
8773@var{sequence-id} and the character @samp{:}, the actual
8774@var{packet-data}, and the terminating character @samp{#} followed by a
8775two-digit @var{checksum}:
8776
8777@example
8778@code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
8779@end example
8780@noindent
8781or, with the optional @var{sequence-id}:
8782@example
8783@code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
8784@end example
8785
8786@cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
8787@noindent
8788The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
8789characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (that
8790consisting of both the optional @var{sequence-id}@code{:} and the actual
d4f3574e 8791@var{packet-data}) (an eight bit unsigned checksum).
104c1213
JM
8792
8793@cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
8794@noindent
8795The two-digit @var{sequence-id}, when present, is returned with the
8796acknowledgment. Beyond that its meaning is poorly defined.
8797@value{GDBN} is not known to output @var{sequence-id}s.
8798
8799When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
8800response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
8801the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
8802retransmission):
8803
8804@example
8805<- @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
8806-> @code{+}
8807@end example
8808@noindent
8809If the received packet included a @var{sequence-id} than that is
8810appended to a positive acknowledgment:
8811
8812@example
8813<- @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
8814-> @code{+}@var{sequence-id}
8815@end example
8816
8817The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
8818debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
8819the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
8820when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
8821
8822@var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
8823exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for an
8824exception). @samp{:} can not appear as the third character in a packet.
8825Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} and @samp{;}
8826(unfortunately some packets chose to use @samp{:}). Except where
8827otherwise noted all numbers are represented in HEX with leading zeros
8828suppressed.
8829
8830Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
c3f6f71d 8831means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
104c1213
JM
8832which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
8833@samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
d4f3574e
SS
8834where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
8835characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
8836value greater than 126 should not be used.
8837
8838Some remote systems have used a different run-length encoding mechanism
8839loosely refered to as the cisco encoding. Following the @samp{*}
8840character are two hex digits that indicate the size of the packet.
104c1213
JM
8841
8842So:
8843@example
8844"@code{0* }"
8845@end example
8846@noindent
8847means the same as "0000".
8848
8849The error response, returned for some packets includes a two character
8850error number. That number is not well defined.
8851
8852For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
8853(@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
8854protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
d4f3574e 8855on that response.
104c1213
JM
8856
8857Below is a complete list of all currently defined @var{command}s and
8858their corresponding response @var{data}:
8859
8860@multitable @columnfractions .30 .30 .40
8861@item Packet
8862@tab Request
8863@tab Description
8864
8865@item extended ops @emph{(optional)}
8866@tab @code{!}
8867@tab
d4f3574e 8868Use the extended remote protocol. Sticky---only needs to be set once.
104c1213
JM
8869The extended remote protocol support the @samp{R} packet.
8870@item
8871@tab reply @samp{}
8872@tab
8873Stubs that support the extended remote protocol return @samp{} which,
8874unfortunately, is identical to the response returned by stubs that do not
8875support protocol extensions.
8876
8877@item last signal
8878@tab @code{?}
8879@tab
d4f3574e
SS
8880Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for step
8881and continue.
8882@item
8883@tab reply
8884@tab see below
8885
104c1213
JM
8886
8887@item reserved
8888@tab @code{a}
8889@tab Reserved for future use
8890
8891@item set program arguments @strong{(reserved)} @emph{(optional)}
8892@tab @code{A}@var{arglen}@code{,}@var{argnum}@code{,}@var{arg}@code{,...}
8893@tab
8894Initialized @samp{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
8895specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream @var{arg}.
d4f3574e 8896See @file{gdbserver} for more details.
104c1213
JM
8897@item
8898@tab reply @code{OK}
8899@item
8900@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
8901
8902@item set baud @strong{(deprecated)}
8903@tab @code{b}@var{baud}
8904@tab
8905Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}. JTC: @emph{When does the
8906transport layer state change? When it's received, or after the ACK is
8907transmitted. In either case, there are problems if the command or the
8908acknowledgment packet is dropped.} Stan: @emph{If people really wanted
8909to add something like this, and get it working for the first time, they
8910ought to modify ser-unix.c to send some kind of out-of-band message to a
8911specially-setup stub and have the switch happen "in between" packets, so
8912that from remote protocol's point of view, nothing actually
8913happened.}
8914
8915@item set breakpoint @strong{(deprecated)}
8916@tab @code{B}@var{addr},@var{mode}
8917@tab
8918Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
8919breakpoint at @var{addr}. @emph{This has been replaced by the @samp{Z} and
8920@samp{z} packets.}
8921
8922@item continue
8923@tab @code{c}@var{addr}
8924@tab
8925@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
8926current address.
8927@item
8928@tab reply
8929@tab see below
8930
8931@item continue with signal @emph{(optional)}
8932@tab @code{C}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr}
8933@tab
8934Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
8935@code{;}@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
8936@item
8937@tab reply
8938@tab see below
8939
d4f3574e 8940@item toggle debug @emph{(deprecated)}
104c1213
JM
8941@tab @code{d}
8942@tab
d4f3574e 8943toggle debug flag.
104c1213
JM
8944
8945@item detach @emph{(optional)}
8946@tab @code{D}
d4f3574e 8947@tab
2df3850c
JM
8948Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target before
8949@value{GDBN} disconnects.
d4f3574e
SS
8950@item
8951@tab reply @emph{no response}
8952@tab
2df3850c 8953@value{GDBN} does not check for any response after sending this packet
104c1213
JM
8954
8955@item reserved
8956@tab @code{e}
8957@tab Reserved for future use
8958
8959@item reserved
8960@tab @code{E}
8961@tab Reserved for future use
8962
8963@item reserved
8964@tab @code{f}
8965@tab Reserved for future use
8966
8967@item reserved
8968@tab @code{F}
8969@tab Reserved for future use
8970
8971@item read registers
8972@tab @code{g}
8973@tab Read general registers.
8974@item
8975@tab reply @var{XX...}
8976@tab
8977Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
8978with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
d4f3574e 8979each register and their position within the @samp{g} @var{packet} are
2df3850c 8980determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros @var{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and
d4f3574e
SS
8981@var{REGISTER_NAME} macros. The specification of several standard
8982@code{g} packets is specified below.
104c1213
JM
8983@item
8984@tab @code{E}@var{NN}
8985@tab for an error.
8986
8987@item write regs
8988@tab @code{G}@var{XX...}
8989@tab
8990See @samp{g} for a description of the @var{XX...} data.
8991@item
8992@tab reply @code{OK}
8993@tab for success
8994@item
8995@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
8996@tab for an error
8997
8998@item reserved
8999@tab @code{h}
9000@tab Reserved for future use
9001
9002@item set thread @emph{(optional)}
9003@tab @code{H}@var{c}@var{t...}
9004@tab
d4f3574e
SS
9005Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
9006@samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} = @samp{c} for thread used in step and
9007continue; @var{t...} can be -1 for all threads. @var{c} = @samp{g} for
9008thread used in other operations. If zero, pick a thread, any thread.
104c1213
JM
9009@item
9010@tab reply @code{OK}
9011@tab for success
9012@item
9013@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9014@tab for an error
9015
d4f3574e
SS
9016@c FIXME: JTC:
9017@c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
9018@c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
9019@c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
9020@c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
9021@c described. For example:
9022@c
9023@c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
9024@c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
9025@c otherwise returns current registers.
9026@c
9027@c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
9028@c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
9029@c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
9030
104c1213
JM
9031@item cycle step @strong{(draft)} @emph{(optional)}
9032@tab @code{i}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{nnn}
9033@tab
9034Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @code{,}@var{nnn} is
9035present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
9036step starting at that address.
9037
9038@item signal then cycle step @strong{(reserved)} @emph{(optional)}
9039@tab @code{I}
9040@tab
9041See @samp{i} and @samp{S} for likely syntax and semantics.
9042
9043@item reserved
9044@tab @code{j}
9045@tab Reserved for future use
9046
9047@item reserved
9048@tab @code{J}
9049@tab Reserved for future use
9050
9051@item kill request @emph{(optional)}
9052@tab @code{k}
9053@tab
d4f3574e
SS
9054FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how operate when a specific
9055thread context has been selected (ie. does 'k' kill only that thread?)}.
104c1213
JM
9056
9057@item reserved
9058@tab @code{l}
9059@tab Reserved for future use
9060
9061@item reserved
9062@tab @code{L}
9063@tab Reserved for future use
9064
9065@item read memory
9066@tab @code{m}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
9067@tab
9068Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
2df3850c 9069Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that sized memory transfers are assumed
d4f3574e
SS
9070using word alligned accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory
9071transfer mechanism is needed.}
104c1213
JM
9072@item
9073@tab reply @var{XX...}
9074@tab
d4f3574e 9075@var{XX...} is mem contents. Can be fewer bytes than requested if able
2df3850c 9076to read only part of the data. Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that
d4f3574e
SS
9077sized memory transfers are assumed using word alligned accesses. FIXME:
9078@emph{A word aligned memory transfer mechanism is needed.}
104c1213
JM
9079@item
9080@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9081@tab @var{NN} is errno
9082
9083@item write mem
9084@tab @code{M}@var{addr},@var{length}@code{:}@var{XX...}
9085@tab
9086Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
9087@var{XX...} is the data.
9088@item
9089@tab reply @code{OK}
9090@tab for success
9091@item
9092@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9093@tab
9094for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
9095written).
9096
9097@item reserved
9098@tab @code{n}
9099@tab Reserved for future use
9100
9101@item reserved
9102@tab @code{N}
9103@tab Reserved for future use
9104
9105@item reserved
9106@tab @code{o}
9107@tab Reserved for future use
9108
9109@item reserved
9110@tab @code{O}
9111@tab Reserved for future use
9112
9113@item read reg @strong{(reserved)}
9114@tab @code{p}@var{n...}
9115@tab
9116See write register.
9117@item
9118@tab return @var{r....}
9119@tab The hex encoded value of the register in target byte order.
9120
9121@item write reg @emph{(optional)}
9122@tab @code{P}@var{n...}@code{=}@var{r...}
9123@tab
9124Write register @var{n...} with value @var{r...}, which contains two hex
9125digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
9126@item
9127@tab reply @code{OK}
9128@tab for success
9129@item
9130@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9131@tab for an error
9132
9133@item general query @emph{(optional)}
9134@tab @code{q}@var{query}
9135@tab
d4f3574e 9136Request info about @var{query}. In general @value{GDBN} @var{query}'s
104c1213 9137have a leading upper case letter. Custom vendor queries should use a
d4f3574e
SS
9138company prefix (in lower case) ex: @samp{qfsf.var}. @var{query} may
9139optionally be followed by a @samp{,} or @samp{;} separated list. Stubs
9140must ensure that they match the full @var{query} name.
104c1213
JM
9141@item
9142@tab reply @code{XX...}
d4f3574e 9143@tab Hex encoded data from query. The reply can not be empty.
104c1213
JM
9144@item
9145@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9146@tab error reply
9147@item
9148@tab reply @samp{}
9149@tab Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
9150
104c1213
JM
9151@item general set @emph{(optional)}
9152@tab @code{Q}@var{var}@code{=}@var{val}
9153@tab
9154Set value of @var{var} to @var{val}. See @samp{q} for a discussing of
9155naming conventions.
9156
d4f3574e
SS
9157@item reset @emph{(deprecated)}
9158@tab @code{r}
9159@tab
9160Reset the entire system.
104c1213
JM
9161
9162@item remote restart @emph{(optional)}
9163@tab @code{R}@var{XX}
9164@tab
d4f3574e
SS
9165Restart the remote server. @var{XX} while needed has no clear
9166definition. FIXME: @emph{An example interaction explaining how this
9167packet is used in extended-remote mode is needed}.
104c1213
JM
9168
9169@item step @emph{(optional)}
9170@tab @code{s}@var{addr}
9171@tab
9172@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
9173same address.
9174@item
9175@tab reply
9176@tab see below
9177
9178@item step with signal @emph{(optional)}
9179@tab @code{S}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr}
9180@tab
9181Like @samp{C} but step not continue.
9182@item
9183@tab reply
9184@tab see below
9185
9186@item search @emph{(optional)}
9187@tab @code{t}@var{addr}@code{:}@var{PP}@code{,}@var{MM}
9188@tab
9189Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
9190@var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4
d4f3574e 9191bytes. @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
104c1213
JM
9192
9193@item thread alive @emph{(optional)}
9194@tab @code{T}@var{XX}
9195@tab Find out if the thread XX is alive.
9196@item
9197@tab reply @code{OK}
9198@tab thread is still alive
9199@item
9200@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9201@tab thread is dead
9202
9203@item reserved
9204@tab @code{u}
9205@tab Reserved for future use
9206
9207@item reserved
9208@tab @code{U}
9209@tab Reserved for future use
9210
9211@item reserved
9212@tab @code{v}
9213@tab Reserved for future use
9214
9215@item reserved
9216@tab @code{V}
9217@tab Reserved for future use
9218
9219@item reserved
9220@tab @code{w}
9221@tab Reserved for future use
9222
9223@item reserved
9224@tab @code{W}
9225@tab Reserved for future use
9226
9227@item reserved
9228@tab @code{x}
9229@tab Reserved for future use
9230
9231@item write mem (binary) @emph{(optional)}
9232@tab @code{X}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}@var{:}@var{XX...}
9233@tab
9234@var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes, @var{XX...} is
d4f3574e
SS
9235binary data. The characters @code{$}, @code{#}, and @code{0x7d} are
9236escaped using @code{0x7d}.
104c1213
JM
9237@item
9238@tab reply @code{OK}
9239@tab for success
9240@item
9241@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9242@tab for an error
9243
9244@item reserved
9245@tab @code{y}
9246@tab Reserved for future use
9247
9248@item reserved
9249@tab @code{Y}
9250@tab Reserved for future use
9251
9252@item remove break or watchpoint @strong{(draft)} @emph{(optional)}
9253@tab @code{z}@var{t}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
9254@tab
9255See @samp{Z}.
9256
9257@item insert break or watchpoint @strong{(draft)} @emph{(optional)}
9258@tab @code{Z}@var{t}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
9259@tab
9260@var{t} is type: @samp{0} - software breakpoint, @samp{1} - hardware
9261breakpoint, @samp{2} - write watchpoint, @samp{3} - read watchpoint,
9262@samp{4} - access watchpoint; @var{addr} is address; @var{length} is in
9263bytes. For a software breakpoint, @var{length} specifies the size of
9264the instruction to be patched. For hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
d4f3574e
SS
9265@var{length} specifies the memory region to be monitored. To avoid
9266potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should be
9267implemented in an ident-potentent way.
104c1213
JM
9268@item
9269@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9270@tab for an error
9271@item
9272@tab reply @code{OK}
9273@tab for success
9274@item
9275@tab @samp{}
9276@tab If not supported.
9277
9278@item reserved
9279@tab <other>
9280@tab Reserved for future use
9281
9282@end multitable
9283
d4f3574e
SS
9284The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
9285receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
9286@samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
9287when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @samp{signal
9288number} is poorly defined. In general one of the UNIX signal numbering
9289conventions is used.
104c1213
JM
9290
9291@multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
9292
9293@item @code{S}@var{AA}
9294@tab @var{AA} is the signal number
9295
9296@item @code{T}@var{AA}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}
9297@tab
9298@var{AA} = two hex digit signal number; @var{n...} = register number
9299(hex), @var{r...} = target byte ordered register contents, size defined
9300by @code{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}; @var{n...} = @samp{thread}, @var{r...} =
9301thread process ID, this is a hex integer; @var{n...} = other string not
d4f3574e 9302starting with valid hex digit. @value{GDBN} should ignore this
104c1213
JM
9303@var{n...}, @var{r...} pair and go on to the next. This way we can
9304extend the protocol.
9305
9306@item @code{W}@var{AA}
9307@tab
9308The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
9309applicable for certains sorts of targets.
9310
9311@item @code{X}@var{AA}
9312@tab
9313The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
9314
9315@item @code{N}@var{AA}@code{;}@var{tttttttt}@code{;}@var{dddddddd}@code{;}@var{bbbbbbbb} @strong{(obsolete)}
9316@tab
9317@var{AA} = signal number; @var{tttttttt} = address of symbol "_start";
9318@var{dddddddd} = base of data section; @var{bbbbbbbb} = base of bss
d4f3574e 9319section. @emph{Note: only used by Cisco Systems targets. The difference
104c1213
JM
9320between this reply and the "qOffsets" query is that the 'N' packet may
9321arrive spontaneously whereas the 'qOffsets' is a query initiated by the
9322host debugger.}
9323
9324@item @code{O}@var{XX...}
9325@tab
c3f6f71d 9326@var{XX...} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data. This can happen at any time
104c1213
JM
9327while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
9328for 'W', 'T', etc.
9329
9330@end multitable
9331
d4f3574e
SS
9332The following set and query packets have already been defined.
9333
9334@multitable @columnfractions .2 .2 .6
9335
9336@item current thread
9337@tab @code{q}@code{C}
9338@tab Return the current thread id.
9339@item
9340@tab reply @code{QC}@var{pid}
9341@tab
9342Where @var{pid} is a HEX encoded 16 bit process id.
9343@item
9344@tab reply *
9345@tab Any other reply implies the old pid.
9346
bba2971c
MS
9347@item all thread ids
9348@tab @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo}
9349@item
9350@tab @code{q}@code{sThreadInfo}
d4f3574e 9351@tab
bba2971c
MS
9352Obtain a list of active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
9353may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
9354works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
9355obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
9356be the @code{qf}@code{ThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
9357sequence will be the @code{qs}@code{ThreadInfo} query.
d4f3574e 9358@item
bba2971c
MS
9359@tab
9360@tab NOTE: replaces the @code{qL} query (see below).
d4f3574e 9361@item
bba2971c
MS
9362@tab reply @code{m}@var{<id>}
9363@tab A single thread id
9364@item
9365@tab reply @code{m}@var{<id>,}@var{<id>...}
9366@tab a comma-separated list of thread ids
9367@item
9368@tab reply @code{l}
9369@tab (lower case 'el') denotes end of list.
9370@item
9371@tab
9372@tab
9373In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one
9374or more thread ids, in big-endian hex, separated by commas. GDB will
9375respond to each reply with a request for more thread ids (using the
9376@code{qs} form of the query), until the target responds with @code{l}
9377(lower-case el, for @code{'last'}).
9378
9379@item extra thread info
9380@tab @code{qfThreadExtraInfo,}@var{<id>}
9381@tab
9382@item
9383@tab
9384@tab
9385Where @var{<id>} is a thread-id in big-endian hex.
9386Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
9387the target OS. This string may contain anything that the target OS
9388thinks is interesting for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread.
9389The string is displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @samp{info threads} display.
9390Some examples of possible thread extra info strings are "Runnable", or
9391"Blocked on Mutex".
9392@item
9393@tab reply @var{XX...}
9394@tab
9395Where @var{XX...} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, comprising the
9396printable string containing the extra information about the thread's
9397attributes.
d4f3574e
SS
9398
9399@item query @var{LIST} or @var{threadLIST} @strong{(deprecated)}
9400@tab @code{q}@code{L}@var{startflag}@var{threadcount}@var{nextthread}
9401@tab
2b628194
MS
9402@item
9403@tab
9404@tab
d4f3574e
SS
9405Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
9406digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
9407subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
9408number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
9409(eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
9410returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
9411@item
bba2971c
MS
9412@tab
9413@tab NOTE: this query is replaced by the @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo}
9414query (see above).
9415@item
d4f3574e
SS
9416@tab reply @code{q}@code{M}@var{count}@var{done}@var{argthread}@var{thread...}
9417@tab
2b628194
MS
9418@item
9419@tab
9420@tab
d4f3574e
SS
9421Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
9422returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
9423and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
9424digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread...} is
9425a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
9426digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
9427
bba2971c
MS
9428@item compute CRC of memory block
9429@tab @code{q}@code{CRC:}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
9430@tab
9431@item
9432@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9433@tab An error (such as memory fault)
9434@item
9435@tab reply @code{C}@var{CRC32}
9436@tab A 32 bit cyclic redundancy check of the specified memory region.
9437
d4f3574e
SS
9438@item query sect offs
9439@tab @code{q}@code{Offsets}
917317f4
JM
9440@tab
9441Get section offsets that the target used when re-locating the downloaded
9442image. @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset is included in the
9443response, @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data}
9444offset to the @code{Bss} section.}
d4f3574e
SS
9445@item
9446@tab reply @code{Text=}@var{xxx}@code{;Data=}@var{yyy}@code{;Bss=}@var{zzz}
9447
9448@item thread info request
9449@tab @code{q}@code{P}@var{mode}@var{threadid}
9450@tab
9451Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
9452encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
9453@item
9454@tab reply *
9455@tab
9456See @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
9457
9458@item remote command
9459@tab @code{q}@code{Rcmd,}@var{COMMAND}
9460@tab
9461@var{COMMAND} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
9462execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output string.
9463Before the final result packet, the target may also respond with a
9464number of intermediate @code{O}@var{OUTPUT} console output
9465packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
9466stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
9467@item
9468@tab reply @code{OK}
9469@tab
9470A command response with no output.
9471@item
9472@tab reply @var{OUTPUT}
9473@tab
9474A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
9475@item
9476@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9477@tab
9478Indicate a badly formed request.
9479
9480@item
9481@tab reply @samp{}
9482@tab
9483When @samp{q}@samp{Rcmd} is not recognized.
9484
9485@end multitable
9486
9487The following @samp{g}/@samp{G} packets have previously been defined.
9488In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as sixty-four
9489bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?) to fill the
9490space allocated. Register bytes are transfered in target byte order.
9491The two nibbles within a register byte are transfered most-significant -
9492least-significant.
9493
9494@multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
9495
9496@item MIPS32
9497@tab
9498All registers are transfered as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
949932 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
9500registers; fsr; fir; fp.
9501
9502@item MIPS64
9503@tab
9504All registers are transfered as sixty-four bit quantities (including
9505thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
9506as @code{MIPS32}.
9507
9508@end multitable
9509
104c1213
JM
9510Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
9511does not get any direct output:
9512
9513@example
9514<- @code{R00}
9515-> @code{+}
9516@emph{target restarts}
9517<- @code{?}
9518-> @code{+}
9519-> @code{T001:1234123412341234}
9520<- @code{+}
9521@end example
9522
9523Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
9524
9525@example
9526<- @code{G1445...}
9527-> @code{+}
9528<- @code{s}
9529-> @code{+}
9530@emph{time passes}
9531-> @code{T001:1234123412341234}
9532<- @code{+}
9533<- @code{g}
9534-> @code{+}
9535-> @code{1455...}
9536<- @code{+}
9537@end example
9538
d4f3574e
SS
9539@kindex set remotedebug@r{, serial protocol}
9540@kindex show remotedebug@r{, serial protocol}
104c1213
JM
9541@cindex packets, reporting on stdout
9542@cindex serial connections, debugging
9543If you have trouble with the serial connection, you can use the command
9544@code{set remotedebug}. This makes @value{GDBN} report on all packets sent
9545back and forth across the serial line to the remote machine. The
9546packet-debugging information is printed on the @value{GDBN} standard output
9547stream. @code{set remotedebug off} turns it off, and @code{show
9548remotedebug} shows you its current state.
9549
9550@node Server
9551@subsubsection Using the @code{gdbserver} program
9552
9553@kindex gdbserver
9554@cindex remote connection without stubs
9555@code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
9556allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
9557@code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
9558
9559@code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
9560because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
9561that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
9562@code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
9563@value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
9564because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
9565also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
9566started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
9567Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
9568the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
9569do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
9570by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
9571choice for debugging.
9572
9573@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
9574or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
9575protocol.
9576
9577@table @emph
9578@item On the target machine,
9579you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
9580@code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
9581strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
9582system does all the symbol handling.
9583
9584To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
9585the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The
9586syntax is:
9587
9588@smallexample
9589target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
9590@end smallexample
9591
9592@var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
9593hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
9594@samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
9595@file{/dev/com1}:
9596
9597@smallexample
9598target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
9599@end smallexample
9600
9601@code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
9602with it.
9603
9604To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
9605
9606@smallexample
9607target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
9608@end smallexample
9609
9610The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
9611specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
9612TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
9613expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
9614(Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
9615you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
9616TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
9617reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
9618conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
d4f3574e 9619and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
104c1213
JM
9620@code{target remote} command.
9621
9622@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
9623you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
9624symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
9625using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
9626(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
d4f3574e 9627running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}.) After that, use @code{target
104c1213
JM
9628remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserver}. Its argument
9629is either a device name (usually a serial device, like
9630@file{/dev/ttyb}), or a TCP port descriptor in the form
9631@code{@var{host}:@var{PORT}}. For example:
9632
9633@smallexample
9634(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
9635@end smallexample
9636
9637@noindent
9638communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and
9639
9640@smallexample
9641(@value{GDBP}) target remote the-target:2345
9642@end smallexample
9643
9644@noindent
9645communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host @w{@file{the-target}}.
9646For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
9647the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
9648text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
9649@samp{Connection refused}.
9650@end table
9651
9652@node NetWare
9653@subsubsection Using the @code{gdbserve.nlm} program
9654
9655@kindex gdbserve.nlm
9656@code{gdbserve.nlm} is a control program for NetWare systems, which
9657allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
9658@code{target remote}.
9659
9660@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserve.nlm} communicate via a serial line,
9661using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol.
9662
9663@table @emph
9664@item On the target machine,
9665you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
9666@code{gdbserve.nlm} does not need your program's symbol table, so you
9667can strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the
9668host system does all the symbol handling.
9669
9670To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with
9671@value{GDBN}; the name of your program; and the arguments for your
9672program. The syntax is:
9673
9674@smallexample
9675load gdbserve [ BOARD=@var{board} ] [ PORT=@var{port} ]
9676 [ BAUD=@var{baud} ] @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
9677@end smallexample
9678
9679@var{board} and @var{port} specify the serial line; @var{baud} specifies
9680the baud rate used by the connection. @var{port} and @var{node} default
d4f3574e 9681to 0, @var{baud} defaults to 9600@dmn{bps}.
104c1213
JM
9682
9683For example, to debug Emacs with the argument @samp{foo.txt}and
9684communicate with @value{GDBN} over serial port number 2 or board 1
d4f3574e 9685using a 19200@dmn{bps} connection:
104c1213
JM
9686
9687@smallexample
9688load gdbserve BOARD=1 PORT=2 BAUD=19200 emacs foo.txt
9689@end smallexample
9690
9691@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
9692you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
9693symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
9694using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
9695(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
d4f3574e 9696running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}. After that, use @code{target
104c1213
JM
9697remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserve.nlm}. Its
9698argument is a device name (usually a serial device, like
9699@file{/dev/ttyb}). For example:
9700
9701@smallexample
9702(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
9703@end smallexample
9704
9705@noindent
9706communications with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}.
9707@end table
9708
9709@node KOD
9710@section Kernel Object Display
9711
9712@cindex kernel object display
9713@cindex kernel object
9714@cindex KOD
9715
9716Some targets support kernel object display. Using this facility,
9717@value{GDBN} communicates specially with the underlying operating system
9718and can display information about operating system-level objects such as
9719mutexes and other synchronization objects. Exactly which objects can be
9720displayed is determined on a per-OS basis.
9721
9722Use the @code{set os} command to set the operating system. This tells
9723@value{GDBN} which kernel object display module to initialize:
9724
9725@example
2df3850c 9726(@value{GDBP}) set os cisco
104c1213
JM
9727@end example
9728
9729If @code{set os} succeeds, @value{GDBN} will display some information
9730about the operating system, and will create a new @code{info} command
9731which can be used to query the target. The @code{info} command is named
9732after the operating system:
9733
9734@example
2df3850c 9735(@value{GDBP}) info cisco
104c1213
JM
9736List of Cisco Kernel Objects
9737Object Description
9738any Any and all objects
9739@end example
9740
9741Further subcommands can be used to query about particular objects known
9742by the kernel.
9743
9744There is currently no way to determine whether a given operating system
96baa820
JM
9745is supported other than to try it.
9746
9747
104c1213
JM
9748@node Configurations
9749@chapter Configuration-Specific Information
9750
9751While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
9752cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
9753describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
9754
9755There are three major categories of configurations: native
9756configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
9757operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
9758different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
9759are quite different from each other.
9760
9761@menu
9762* Native::
9763* Embedded OS::
9764* Embedded Processors::
9765* Architectures::
9766@end menu
9767
9768@node Native
9769@section Native
9770
9771This section describes details specific to particular native
9772configurations.
9773
9774@menu
9775* HP-UX:: HP-UX
9776* SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
9777@end menu
9778
9779@node HP-UX
9780@subsection HP-UX
9781
9782On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
9783begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
9784name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
9785
9786@node SVR4 Process Information
9787@subsection SVR4 process information
9788
9789@kindex /proc
9790@cindex process image
9791
9792Many versions of SVR4 provide a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
9793used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
9794subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with
9795this facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report on
9796several kinds of information about the process running your program.
9797@code{info proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the
9798@code{procfs} code. This includes OSF/1 (Digital Unix), Solaris, Irix,
9799and Unixware, but not HP-UX or Linux, for example.
9800
9801@table @code
9802@kindex info proc
9803@item info proc
9804Summarize available information about the process.
9805
9806@kindex info proc mappings
9807@item info proc mappings
9808Report on the address ranges accessible in the program, with information
9809on whether your program may read, write, or execute each range.
9810
9811@kindex info proc times
9812@item info proc times
9813Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
9814its children.
9815
9816@kindex info proc id
9817@item info proc id
9818Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
9819the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
9820
9821@kindex info proc status
9822@item info proc status
9823General information on the state of the process. If the process is
9824stopped, this report includes the reason for stopping, and any signal
9825received.
9826
9827@item info proc all
9828Show all the above information about the process.
9829@end table
9830
9831@node Embedded OS
9832@section Embedded Operating Systems
9833
9834This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
9835embedded operating systems that are available for several different
9836architectures.
9837
9838@menu
9839* VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
9840@end menu
9841
9842@value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
9843various real-time operating systems.
9844
9845@node VxWorks
9846@subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
9847
9848@cindex VxWorks
9849
9850@table @code
9851
9852@kindex target vxworks
9853@item target vxworks @var{machinename}
9854A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
9855is the target system's machine name or IP address.
9856
9857@end table
9858
9859On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
9860current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
9861
9862@value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
9863VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
9864the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
9865both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
d4f3574e 9866@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
104c1213 9867installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
96a2c332 9868@value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
104c1213
JM
9869
9870@table @code
9871@item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
9872@kindex vxworks-timeout
9873All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
9874This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
9875seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
9876your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
9877of a thin network line.
9878@end table
9879
9880The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
9881this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
9882procedures.
9883
9884@kindex INCLUDE_RDB
9885To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
9886to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
9887library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
9888VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
9889kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
9890source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
9891information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
9892manual.
9893@c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
9894
9895Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
9896your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
96a2c332
SS
9897run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
9898@code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
104c1213
JM
9899
9900@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
9901
9902@example
9903(vxgdb)
9904@end example
9905
9906@menu
9907* VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
9908* VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
9909* VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
9910@end menu
9911
9912@node VxWorks Connection
9913@subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
9914
9915The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
9916network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
9917
9918@example
9919(vxgdb) target vxworks tt
9920@end example
9921
9922@need 750
9923@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
9924
9925@smallexample
9926Attaching remote machine across net...
9927Connected to tt.
9928@end smallexample
9929
9930@need 1000
9931@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
9932loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
9933these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
9934path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}); if it fails
9935to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
9936
9937@example
9938prog.o: No such file or directory.
9939@end example
9940
9941When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
9942the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
9943command again.
9944
9945@node VxWorks Download
9946@subsubsection VxWorks download
9947
9948@cindex download to VxWorks
9949If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
9950object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
9951@code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
9952incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
9953command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
9954to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
9955table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
9956the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
9957filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
9958Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
9959to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
9960the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
9961@file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
9962and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
9963program, type this on VxWorks:
9964
9965@example
9966-> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
9967@end example
d4f3574e
SS
9968
9969@noindent
104c1213
JM
9970Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
9971
9972@example
9973(vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
9974(vxgdb) load prog.o
9975@end example
9976
9977@value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
9978
9979@smallexample
9980Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
9981@end smallexample
9982
9983You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
9984after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
9985this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
9986auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
9987history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
d4f3574e 9988debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
104c1213
JM
9989table.)
9990
9991@node VxWorks Attach
9992@subsubsection Running tasks
9993
9994@cindex running VxWorks tasks
9995You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
9996follows:
9997
9998@example
9999(vxgdb) attach @var{task}
10000@end example
10001
10002@noindent
10003where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
10004or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
10005the time of attachment.
10006
10007@node Embedded Processors
10008@section Embedded Processors
10009
10010This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
10011configurations.
10012
10013@menu
10014* A29K Embedded:: AMD A29K Embedded
10015* ARM:: ARM
10016* H8/300:: Hitachi H8/300
10017* H8/500:: Hitachi H8/500
10018* i960:: Intel i960
10019* M32R/D:: Mitsubishi M32R/D
10020* M68K:: Motorola M68K
10021* M88K:: Motorola M88K
10022* MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
10023* PA:: HP PA Embedded
10024* PowerPC: PowerPC
10025* SH:: Hitachi SH
10026* Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
10027* Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
10028* ST2000:: Tandem ST2000
10029* Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
10030@end menu
10031
10032@node A29K Embedded
10033@subsection AMD A29K Embedded
10034
10035@menu
10036* A29K UDI::
10037* A29K EB29K::
10038* Comms (EB29K):: Communications setup
10039* gdb-EB29K:: EB29K cross-debugging
10040* Remote Log:: Remote log
10041@end menu
10042
10043@table @code
10044
10045@kindex target adapt
10046@item target adapt @var{dev}
10047Adapt monitor for A29K.
10048
10049@kindex target amd-eb
10050@item target amd-eb @var{dev} @var{speed} @var{PROG}
10051@cindex AMD EB29K
10052Remote PC-resident AMD EB29K board, attached over serial lines.
10053@var{dev} is the serial device, as for @code{target remote};
10054@var{speed} allows you to specify the linespeed; and @var{PROG} is the
10055name of the program to be debugged, as it appears to DOS on the PC.
10056@xref{A29K EB29K, ,EBMON protocol for AMD29K}.
10057
10058@end table
10059
10060@node A29K UDI
10061@subsubsection A29K UDI
10062
10063@cindex UDI
10064@cindex AMD29K via UDI
10065
10066@value{GDBN} supports AMD's UDI (``Universal Debugger Interface'')
10067protocol for debugging the a29k processor family. To use this
10068configuration with AMD targets running the MiniMON monitor, you need the
10069program @code{MONTIP}, available from AMD at no charge. You can also
10070use @value{GDBN} with the UDI-conformant a29k simulator program
10071@code{ISSTIP}, also available from AMD.
10072
10073@table @code
10074@item target udi @var{keyword}
10075@kindex udi
10076Select the UDI interface to a remote a29k board or simulator, where
10077@var{keyword} is an entry in the AMD configuration file @file{udi_soc}.
10078This file contains keyword entries which specify parameters used to
10079connect to a29k targets. If the @file{udi_soc} file is not in your
10080working directory, you must set the environment variable @samp{UDICONF}
10081to its pathname.
10082@end table
10083
10084@node A29K EB29K
10085@subsubsection EBMON protocol for AMD29K
10086
10087@cindex EB29K board
10088@cindex running 29K programs
10089
10090AMD distributes a 29K development board meant to fit in a PC, together
10091with a DOS-hosted monitor program called @code{EBMON}. As a shorthand
10092term, this development system is called the ``EB29K''. To use
10093@value{GDBN} from a Unix system to run programs on the EB29K board, you
10094must first connect a serial cable between the PC (which hosts the EB29K
10095board) and a serial port on the Unix system. In the following, we
10096assume you've hooked the cable between the PC's @file{COM1} port and
10097@file{/dev/ttya} on the Unix system.
10098
10099@node Comms (EB29K)
10100@subsubsection Communications setup
10101
10102The next step is to set up the PC's port, by doing something like this
10103in DOS on the PC:
10104
10105@example
10106C:\> MODE com1:9600,n,8,1,none
10107@end example
10108
10109@noindent
10110This example---run on an MS DOS 4.0 system---sets the PC port to 9600
10111bps, no parity, eight data bits, one stop bit, and no ``retry'' action;
10112you must match the communications parameters when establishing the Unix
10113end of the connection as well.
10114@c FIXME: Who knows what this "no retry action" crud from the DOS manual may
10115@c mean? It's optional; leave it out? ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
d4f3574e
SS
10116@c
10117@c It's optional, but it's unwise to omit it: who knows what is the
10118@c default value set when the DOS machines boots? "No retry" means that
10119@c the DOS serial device driver won't retry the operation if it fails;
10120@c I understand that this is needed because the GDB serial protocol
10121@c handles any errors and retransmissions itself. ---Eli Zaretskii, 3sep99
104c1213
JM
10122
10123To give control of the PC to the Unix side of the serial line, type
10124the following at the DOS console:
10125
10126@example
10127C:\> CTTY com1
10128@end example
10129
10130@noindent
10131(Later, if you wish to return control to the DOS console, you can use
10132the command @code{CTTY con}---but you must send it over the device that
96a2c332 10133had control, in our example over the @file{COM1} serial line.)
104c1213
JM
10134
10135From the Unix host, use a communications program such as @code{tip} or
10136@code{cu} to communicate with the PC; for example,
10137
10138@example
10139cu -s 9600 -l /dev/ttya
10140@end example
10141
10142@noindent
10143The @code{cu} options shown specify, respectively, the linespeed and the
10144serial port to use. If you use @code{tip} instead, your command line
10145may look something like the following:
10146
10147@example
10148tip -9600 /dev/ttya
10149@end example
10150
10151@noindent
10152Your system may require a different name where we show
10153@file{/dev/ttya} as the argument to @code{tip}. The communications
10154parameters, including which port to use, are associated with the
10155@code{tip} argument in the ``remote'' descriptions file---normally the
10156system table @file{/etc/remote}.
10157@c FIXME: What if anything needs doing to match the "n,8,1,none" part of
10158@c the DOS side's comms setup? cu can support -o (odd
10159@c parity), -e (even parity)---apparently no settings for no parity or
10160@c for character size. Taken from stty maybe...? John points out tip
10161@c can set these as internal variables, eg ~s parity=none; man stty
10162@c suggests that it *might* work to stty these options with stdin or
10163@c stdout redirected... ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
d4f3574e
SS
10164@c
10165@c There's nothing to be done for the "none" part of the DOS MODE
10166@c command. The rest of the parameters should be matched by the
10167@c baudrate, bits, and parity used by the Unix side. ---Eli Zaretskii, 3Sep99
104c1213
JM
10168
10169@kindex EBMON
10170Using the @code{tip} or @code{cu} connection, change the DOS working
10171directory to the directory containing a copy of your 29K program, then
10172start the PC program @code{EBMON} (an EB29K control program supplied
10173with your board by AMD). You should see an initial display from
10174@code{EBMON} similar to the one that follows, ending with the
10175@code{EBMON} prompt @samp{#}---
10176
10177@example
10178C:\> G:
10179
10180G:\> CD \usr\joe\work29k
10181
10182G:\USR\JOE\WORK29K> EBMON
10183Am29000 PC Coprocessor Board Monitor, version 3.0-18
10184Copyright 1990 Advanced Micro Devices, Inc.
10185Written by Gibbons and Associates, Inc.
10186
10187Enter '?' or 'H' for help
10188
10189PC Coprocessor Type = EB29K
10190I/O Base = 0x208
10191Memory Base = 0xd0000
10192
10193Data Memory Size = 2048KB
10194Available I-RAM Range = 0x8000 to 0x1fffff
10195Available D-RAM Range = 0x80002000 to 0x801fffff
10196
10197PageSize = 0x400
10198Register Stack Size = 0x800
10199Memory Stack Size = 0x1800
10200
10201CPU PRL = 0x3
10202Am29027 Available = No
10203Byte Write Available = Yes
10204
10205# ~.
10206@end example
10207
10208Then exit the @code{cu} or @code{tip} program (done in the example by
10209typing @code{~.} at the @code{EBMON} prompt). @code{EBMON} keeps
10210running, ready for @value{GDBN} to take over.
10211
10212For this example, we've assumed what is probably the most convenient
10213way to make sure the same 29K program is on both the PC and the Unix
d4f3574e 10214system: a PC/NFS connection that establishes ``drive @file{G:}'' on the
104c1213
JM
10215PC as a file system on the Unix host. If you do not have PC/NFS or
10216something similar connecting the two systems, you must arrange some
10217other way---perhaps floppy-disk transfer---of getting the 29K program
10218from the Unix system to the PC; @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} download it over the
10219serial line.
10220
10221@node gdb-EB29K
10222@subsubsection EB29K cross-debugging
10223
10224Finally, @code{cd} to the directory containing an image of your 29K
10225program on the Unix system, and start @value{GDBN}---specifying as argument the
10226name of your 29K program:
10227
10228@example
10229cd /usr/joe/work29k
10230@value{GDBP} myfoo
10231@end example
10232
10233@need 500
10234Now you can use the @code{target} command:
10235
10236@example
10237target amd-eb /dev/ttya 9600 MYFOO
10238@c FIXME: test above 'target amd-eb' as spelled, with caps! caps are meant to
10239@c emphasize that this is the name as seen by DOS (since I think DOS is
10240@c single-minded about case of letters). ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
10241@end example
10242
10243@noindent
10244In this example, we've assumed your program is in a file called
10245@file{myfoo}. Note that the filename given as the last argument to
10246@code{target amd-eb} should be the name of the program as it appears to DOS.
10247In our example this is simply @code{MYFOO}, but in general it can include
10248a DOS path, and depending on your transfer mechanism may not resemble
10249the name on the Unix side.
10250
10251At this point, you can set any breakpoints you wish; when you are ready
10252to see your program run on the 29K board, use the @value{GDBN} command
10253@code{run}.
10254
10255To stop debugging the remote program, use the @value{GDBN} @code{detach}
10256command.
10257
10258To return control of the PC to its console, use @code{tip} or @code{cu}
10259once again, after your @value{GDBN} session has concluded, to attach to
10260@code{EBMON}. You can then type the command @code{q} to shut down
10261@code{EBMON}, returning control to the DOS command-line interpreter.
d4f3574e 10262Type @kbd{CTTY con} to return command input to the main DOS console,
104c1213
JM
10263and type @kbd{~.} to leave @code{tip} or @code{cu}.
10264
10265@node Remote Log
10266@subsubsection Remote log
10267@kindex eb.log
10268@cindex log file for EB29K
10269
10270The @code{target amd-eb} command creates a file @file{eb.log} in the
10271current working directory, to help debug problems with the connection.
10272@file{eb.log} records all the output from @code{EBMON}, including echoes
10273of the commands sent to it. Running @samp{tail -f} on this file in
10274another window often helps to understand trouble with @code{EBMON}, or
10275unexpected events on the PC side of the connection.
10276
10277@node ARM
10278@subsection ARM
10279
10280@table @code
10281
10282@kindex target rdi
10283@item target rdi @var{dev}
10284ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
10285use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
10286monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
10287
10288@kindex target rdp
10289@item target rdp @var{dev}
10290ARM Demon monitor.
10291
10292@end table
10293
10294@node H8/300
10295@subsection Hitachi H8/300
10296
10297@table @code
10298
d4f3574e 10299@kindex target hms@r{, with H8/300}
104c1213
JM
10300@item target hms @var{dev}
10301A Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500 board, attached via serial line to your host.
10302Use special commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial
10303line and the communications speed used.
10304
d4f3574e 10305@kindex target e7000@r{, with H8/300}
104c1213
JM
10306@item target e7000 @var{dev}
10307E7000 emulator for Hitachi H8 and SH.
10308
d4f3574e
SS
10309@kindex target sh3@r{, with H8/300}
10310@kindex target sh3e@r{, with H8/300}
104c1213 10311@item target sh3 @var{dev}
96a2c332 10312@itemx target sh3e @var{dev}
104c1213
JM
10313Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
10314
10315@end table
10316
10317@cindex download to H8/300 or H8/500
10318@cindex H8/300 or H8/500 download
10319@cindex download to Hitachi SH
10320@cindex Hitachi SH download
10321When you select remote debugging to a Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500
10322board, the @code{load} command downloads your program to the Hitachi
10323board and also opens it as the current executable target for
10324@value{GDBN} on your host (like the @code{file} command).
10325
10326@value{GDBN} needs to know these things to talk to your
10327Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500:
10328
10329@enumerate
10330@item
10331that you want to use @samp{target hms}, the remote debugging interface
10332for Hitachi microprocessors, or @samp{target e7000}, the in-circuit
10333emulator for the Hitachi SH and the Hitachi 300H. (@samp{target hms} is
2df3850c 10334the default when @value{GDBN} is configured specifically for the Hitachi SH,
104c1213
JM
10335H8/300, or H8/500.)
10336
10337@item
10338what serial device connects your host to your Hitachi board (the first
10339serial device available on your host is the default).
10340
10341@item
10342what speed to use over the serial device.
10343@end enumerate
10344
10345@menu
10346* Hitachi Boards:: Connecting to Hitachi boards.
10347* Hitachi ICE:: Using the E7000 In-Circuit Emulator.
10348* Hitachi Special:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros.
10349@end menu
10350
10351@node Hitachi Boards
10352@subsubsection Connecting to Hitachi boards
10353
10354@c only for Unix hosts
10355@kindex device
10356@cindex serial device, Hitachi micros
96a2c332 10357Use the special @code{@value{GDBN}} command @samp{device @var{port}} if you
104c1213
JM
10358need to explicitly set the serial device. The default @var{port} is the
10359first available port on your host. This is only necessary on Unix
10360hosts, where it is typically something like @file{/dev/ttya}.
10361
10362@kindex speed
10363@cindex serial line speed, Hitachi micros
96a2c332 10364@code{@value{GDBN}} has another special command to set the communications
104c1213 10365speed: @samp{speed @var{bps}}. This command also is only used from Unix
2df3850c 10366hosts; on DOS hosts, set the line speed as usual from outside @value{GDBN} with
d4f3574e
SS
10367the DOS @code{mode} command (for instance,
10368@w{@kbd{mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p}} for a 9600@dmn{bps} connection).
104c1213
JM
10369
10370The @samp{device} and @samp{speed} commands are available only when you
10371use a Unix host to debug your Hitachi microprocessor programs. If you
10372use a DOS host,
10373@value{GDBN} depends on an auxiliary terminate-and-stay-resident program
10374called @code{asynctsr} to communicate with the development board
10375through a PC serial port. You must also use the DOS @code{mode} command
10376to set up the serial port on the DOS side.
10377
10378The following sample session illustrates the steps needed to start a
10379program under @value{GDBN} control on an H8/300. The example uses a
10380sample H8/300 program called @file{t.x}. The procedure is the same for
10381the Hitachi SH and the H8/500.
10382
10383First hook up your development board. In this example, we use a
10384board attached to serial port @code{COM2}; if you use a different serial
10385port, substitute its name in the argument of the @code{mode} command.
10386When you call @code{asynctsr}, the auxiliary comms program used by the
d4f3574e 10387debugger, you give it just the numeric part of the serial port's name;
104c1213
JM
10388for example, @samp{asyncstr 2} below runs @code{asyncstr} on
10389@code{COM2}.
10390
10391@example
10392C:\H8300\TEST> asynctsr 2
10393C:\H8300\TEST> mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p
10394
10395Resident portion of MODE loaded
10396
10397COM2: 9600, n, 8, 1, p
10398
10399@end example
10400
10401@quotation
10402@emph{Warning:} We have noticed a bug in PC-NFS that conflicts with
10403@code{asynctsr}. If you also run PC-NFS on your DOS host, you may need to
10404disable it, or even boot without it, to use @code{asynctsr} to control
10405your development board.
10406@end quotation
10407
d4f3574e 10408@kindex target hms@r{, and serial protocol}
104c1213
JM
10409Now that serial communications are set up, and the development board is
10410connected, you can start up @value{GDBN}. Call @code{@value{GDBP}} with
96a2c332 10411the name of your program as the argument. @code{@value{GDBN}} prompts
104c1213
JM
10412you, as usual, with the prompt @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. Use two special
10413commands to begin your debugging session: @samp{target hms} to specify
10414cross-debugging to the Hitachi board, and the @code{load} command to
10415download your program to the board. @code{load} displays the names of
10416the program's sections, and a @samp{*} for each 2K of data downloaded.
10417(If you want to refresh @value{GDBN} data on symbols or on the
10418executable file without downloading, use the @value{GDBN} commands
10419@code{file} or @code{symbol-file}. These commands, and @code{load}
10420itself, are described in @ref{Files,,Commands to specify files}.)
10421
10422@smallexample
10423(eg-C:\H8300\TEST) @value{GDBP} t.x
2df3850c 10424@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
104c1213
JM
10425 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
10426 the conditions.
2df3850c 10427There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
104c1213 10428for details.
2df3850c
JM
10429@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
10430(@value{GDBP}) target hms
104c1213 10431Connected to remote H8/300 HMS system.
2df3850c 10432(@value{GDBP}) load t.x
104c1213
JM
10433.text : 0x8000 .. 0xabde ***********
10434.data : 0xabde .. 0xad30 *
10435.stack : 0xf000 .. 0xf014 *
10436@end smallexample
10437
10438At this point, you're ready to run or debug your program. From here on,
10439you can use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands. The @code{break} command
10440sets breakpoints; the @code{run} command starts your program;
10441@code{print} or @code{x} display data; the @code{continue} command
10442resumes execution after stopping at a breakpoint. You can use the
10443@code{help} command at any time to find out more about @value{GDBN} commands.
10444
10445Remember, however, that @emph{operating system} facilities aren't
10446available on your development board; for example, if your program hangs,
10447you can't send an interrupt---but you can press the @sc{reset} switch!
10448
10449Use the @sc{reset} button on the development board
10450@itemize @bullet
10451@item
10452to interrupt your program (don't use @kbd{ctl-C} on the DOS host---it has
10453no way to pass an interrupt signal to the development board); and
10454
10455@item
10456to return to the @value{GDBN} command prompt after your program finishes
10457normally. The communications protocol provides no other way for @value{GDBN}
10458to detect program completion.
10459@end itemize
10460
10461In either case, @value{GDBN} sees the effect of a @sc{reset} on the
10462development board as a ``normal exit'' of your program.
10463
10464@node Hitachi ICE
10465@subsubsection Using the E7000 in-circuit emulator
10466
d4f3574e 10467@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi ICE}
104c1213
JM
10468You can use the E7000 in-circuit emulator to develop code for either the
10469Hitachi SH or the H8/300H. Use one of these forms of the @samp{target
10470e7000} command to connect @value{GDBN} to your E7000:
10471
10472@table @code
10473@item target e7000 @var{port} @var{speed}
10474Use this form if your E7000 is connected to a serial port. The
10475@var{port} argument identifies what serial port to use (for example,
10476@samp{com2}). The third argument is the line speed in bits per second
10477(for example, @samp{9600}).
10478
10479@item target e7000 @var{hostname}
10480If your E7000 is installed as a host on a TCP/IP network, you can just
10481specify its hostname; @value{GDBN} uses @code{telnet} to connect.
10482@end table
10483
10484@node Hitachi Special
10485@subsubsection Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros
10486
10487Some @value{GDBN} commands are available only for the H8/300:
10488
10489@table @code
10490
10491@kindex set machine
10492@kindex show machine
10493@item set machine h8300
10494@itemx set machine h8300h
10495Condition @value{GDBN} for one of the two variants of the H8/300
10496architecture with @samp{set machine}. You can use @samp{show machine}
10497to check which variant is currently in effect.
10498
10499@end table
10500
10501@node H8/500
10502@subsection H8/500
10503
10504@table @code
10505
10506@kindex set memory @var{mod}
10507@cindex memory models, H8/500
10508@item set memory @var{mod}
10509@itemx show memory
10510Specify which H8/500 memory model (@var{mod}) you are using with
10511@samp{set memory}; check which memory model is in effect with @samp{show
10512memory}. The accepted values for @var{mod} are @code{small},
10513@code{big}, @code{medium}, and @code{compact}.
10514
10515@end table
10516
10517@node i960
10518@subsection Intel i960
10519
10520@table @code
10521
10522@kindex target mon960
10523@item target mon960 @var{dev}
10524MON960 monitor for Intel i960.
10525
10526@item target nindy @var{devicename}
10527An Intel 960 board controlled by a Nindy Monitor. @var{devicename} is
10528the name of the serial device to use for the connection, e.g.
10529@file{/dev/ttya}.
10530
10531@end table
10532
10533@cindex Nindy
10534@cindex i960
10535@dfn{Nindy} is a ROM Monitor program for Intel 960 target systems. When
10536@value{GDBN} is configured to control a remote Intel 960 using Nindy, you can
10537tell @value{GDBN} how to connect to the 960 in several ways:
10538
10539@itemize @bullet
10540@item
10541Through command line options specifying serial port, version of the
10542Nindy protocol, and communications speed;
10543
10544@item
10545By responding to a prompt on startup;
10546
10547@item
10548By using the @code{target} command at any point during your @value{GDBN}
10549session. @xref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}.
10550
10551@kindex target nindy
10552@item target nindy @var{devicename}
10553An Intel 960 board controlled by a Nindy Monitor. @var{devicename} is
10554the name of the serial device to use for the connection, e.g.
10555@file{/dev/ttya}.
10556
10557@end itemize
10558
10559@cindex download to Nindy-960
10560With the Nindy interface to an Intel 960 board, @code{load}
10561downloads @var{filename} to the 960 as well as adding its symbols in
10562@value{GDBN}.
10563
10564@menu
10565* Nindy Startup:: Startup with Nindy
10566* Nindy Options:: Options for Nindy
10567* Nindy Reset:: Nindy reset command
10568@end menu
10569
10570@node Nindy Startup
10571@subsubsection Startup with Nindy
10572
10573If you simply start @code{@value{GDBP}} without using any command-line
10574options, you are prompted for what serial port to use, @emph{before} you
10575reach the ordinary @value{GDBN} prompt:
10576
10577@example
10578Attach /dev/ttyNN -- specify NN, or "quit" to quit:
10579@end example
10580
10581@noindent
10582Respond to the prompt with whatever suffix (after @samp{/dev/tty})
10583identifies the serial port you want to use. You can, if you choose,
10584simply start up with no Nindy connection by responding to the prompt
10585with an empty line. If you do this and later wish to attach to Nindy,
10586use @code{target} (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
10587
10588@node Nindy Options
10589@subsubsection Options for Nindy
10590
10591These are the startup options for beginning your @value{GDBN} session with a
10592Nindy-960 board attached:
10593
10594@table @code
10595@item -r @var{port}
10596Specify the serial port name of a serial interface to be used to connect
10597to the target system. This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is
10598configured for the Intel 960 target architecture. You may specify
10599@var{port} as any of: a full pathname (e.g. @samp{-r /dev/ttya}), a
10600device name in @file{/dev} (e.g. @samp{-r ttya}), or simply the unique
10601suffix for a specific @code{tty} (e.g. @samp{-r a}).
10602
10603@item -O
10604(An uppercase letter ``O'', not a zero.) Specify that @value{GDBN} should use
10605the ``old'' Nindy monitor protocol to connect to the target system.
10606This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is configured for the Intel 960
10607target architecture.
10608
10609@quotation
10610@emph{Warning:} if you specify @samp{-O}, but are actually trying to
10611connect to a target system that expects the newer protocol, the connection
10612fails, appearing to be a speed mismatch. @value{GDBN} repeatedly
10613attempts to reconnect at several different line speeds. You can abort
10614this process with an interrupt.
10615@end quotation
10616
10617@item -brk
10618Specify that @value{GDBN} should first send a @code{BREAK} signal to the target
10619system, in an attempt to reset it, before connecting to a Nindy target.
10620
10621@quotation
10622@emph{Warning:} Many target systems do not have the hardware that this
10623requires; it only works with a few boards.
10624@end quotation
10625@end table
10626
10627The standard @samp{-b} option controls the line speed used on the serial
10628port.
10629
10630@c @group
10631@node Nindy Reset
10632@subsubsection Nindy reset command
10633
10634@table @code
10635@item reset
10636@kindex reset
10637For a Nindy target, this command sends a ``break'' to the remote target
10638system; this is only useful if the target has been equipped with a
10639circuit to perform a hard reset (or some other interesting action) when
10640a break is detected.
10641@end table
10642@c @end group
10643
10644@node M32R/D
10645@subsection Mitsubishi M32R/D
10646
10647@table @code
10648
10649@kindex target m32r
10650@item target m32r @var{dev}
10651Mitsubishi M32R/D ROM monitor.
10652
10653@end table
10654
10655@node M68K
10656@subsection M68k
10657
10658The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and
10659target command for the following ROM monitors.
10660
10661@table @code
10662
10663@kindex target abug
10664@item target abug @var{dev}
10665ABug ROM monitor for M68K.
10666
10667@kindex target cpu32bug
10668@item target cpu32bug @var{dev}
10669CPU32BUG monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
10670
10671@kindex target dbug
10672@item target dbug @var{dev}
10673dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
10674
10675@kindex target est
10676@item target est @var{dev}
10677EST-300 ICE monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
10678
10679@kindex target rom68k
10680@item target rom68k @var{dev}
10681ROM 68K monitor, running on an M68K IDP board.
10682
10683@end table
10684
10685If @value{GDBN} is configured with @code{m68*-ericsson-*}, it will
10686instead have only a single special target command:
10687
10688@table @code
10689
10690@kindex target es1800
10691@item target es1800 @var{dev}
10692ES-1800 emulator for M68K.
10693
10694@end table
10695
10696[context?]
10697
10698@table @code
10699
10700@kindex target rombug
10701@item target rombug @var{dev}
10702ROMBUG ROM monitor for OS/9000.
10703
10704@end table
10705
10706@node M88K
10707@subsection M88K
10708
10709@table @code
10710
10711@kindex target bug
10712@item target bug @var{dev}
10713BUG monitor, running on a MVME187 (m88k) board.
10714
10715@end table
10716
10717@node MIPS Embedded
10718@subsection MIPS Embedded
10719
10720@cindex MIPS boards
10721@value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
10722MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
10723you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
10724
10725@need 1000
10726Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
10727
10728@table @code
10729@item target mips @var{port}
10730@kindex target mips @var{port}
10731To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
10732name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
10733command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
10734the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
10735been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
10736download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
10737
10738For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
10739port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
10740debugger:
10741
10742@example
10743host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
2df3850c
JM
10744@value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
10745(@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
10746(@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
10747(@value{GDBP}) run
104c1213
JM
10748@end example
10749
10750@item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
10751On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
10752connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
10753concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
10754@samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
10755
10756@item target pmon @var{port}
10757@kindex target pmon @var{port}
10758PMON ROM monitor.
10759
10760@item target ddb @var{port}
10761@kindex target ddb @var{port}
10762NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
10763
10764@item target lsi @var{port}
10765@kindex target lsi @var{port}
10766LSI variant of PMON.
10767
10768@kindex target r3900
10769@item target r3900 @var{dev}
10770Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
10771
10772@kindex target array
10773@item target array @var{dev}
10774Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
10775
10776@end table
10777
10778
10779@noindent
10780@value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
10781
10782@table @code
10783@item set processor @var{args}
10784@itemx show processor
10785@kindex set processor @var{args}
10786@kindex show processor
10787Use the @code{set processor} command to set the type of MIPS
10788processor when you want to access processor-type-specific registers.
10789For example, @code{set processor @var{r3041}} tells @value{GDBN}
10790to use the CPO registers appropriate for the 3041 chip.
10791Use the @code{show processor} command to see what MIPS processor @value{GDBN}
10792is using. Use the @code{info reg} command to see what registers
10793@value{GDBN} is using.
10794
10795@item set mipsfpu double
10796@itemx set mipsfpu single
10797@itemx set mipsfpu none
10798@itemx show mipsfpu
10799@kindex set mipsfpu
10800@kindex show mipsfpu
10801@cindex MIPS remote floating point
10802@cindex floating point, MIPS remote
10803If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
10804coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
96a2c332 10805need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
104c1213
JM
10806file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
10807functions which return floating point values. It also allows
10808@value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
10809functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
10810with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
10811processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
10812double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
10813@samp{set mipsfpu double}.
10814
10815In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
10816floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
10817and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
10818
10819As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
10820@samp{show mipsfpu}.
10821
10822@item set remotedebug @var{n}
10823@itemx show remotedebug
d4f3574e
SS
10824@kindex set remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
10825@kindex show remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
104c1213
JM
10826@cindex @code{remotedebug}, MIPS protocol
10827@cindex MIPS @code{remotedebug} protocol
10828@c FIXME! For this to be useful, you must know something about the MIPS
10829@c FIXME...protocol. Where is it described?
10830You can see some debugging information about communications with the board
10831by setting the @code{remotedebug} variable. If you set it to @code{1} using
10832@samp{set remotedebug 1}, every packet is displayed. If you set it
10833to @code{2}, every character is displayed. You can check the current value
10834at any time with the command @samp{show remotedebug}.
10835
10836@item set timeout @var{seconds}
10837@itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
10838@itemx show timeout
10839@itemx show retransmit-timeout
10840@cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
10841@cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
10842@kindex set timeout
10843@kindex show timeout
10844@kindex set retransmit-timeout
10845@kindex show retransmit-timeout
10846You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
10847remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
10848default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
10849waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
10850retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
10851You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
10852retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
10853@value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
10854
10855The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
10856is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
10857forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
10858to run before stopping.
10859@end table
10860
10861@node PowerPC
10862@subsection PowerPC
10863
10864@table @code
10865
10866@kindex target dink32
10867@item target dink32 @var{dev}
10868DINK32 ROM monitor.
10869
10870@kindex target ppcbug
10871@item target ppcbug @var{dev}
10872@kindex target ppcbug1
10873@item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
10874PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
10875
10876@kindex target sds
10877@item target sds @var{dev}
10878SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
10879
10880@end table
10881
10882@node PA
10883@subsection HP PA Embedded
10884
10885@table @code
10886
10887@kindex target op50n
10888@item target op50n @var{dev}
10889OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
10890
10891@kindex target w89k
10892@item target w89k @var{dev}
10893W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
10894
10895@end table
10896
10897@node SH
10898@subsection Hitachi SH
10899
10900@table @code
10901
d4f3574e 10902@kindex target hms@r{, with Hitachi SH}
104c1213
JM
10903@item target hms @var{dev}
10904A Hitachi SH board attached via serial line to your host. Use special
10905commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial line and
10906the communications speed used.
10907
d4f3574e 10908@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi SH}
104c1213
JM
10909@item target e7000 @var{dev}
10910E7000 emulator for Hitachi SH.
10911
d4f3574e
SS
10912@kindex target sh3@r{, with SH}
10913@kindex target sh3e@r{, with SH}
104c1213
JM
10914@item target sh3 @var{dev}
10915@item target sh3e @var{dev}
10916Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
10917
10918@end table
10919
10920@node Sparclet
10921@subsection Tsqware Sparclet
10922
10923@cindex Sparclet
10924
10925@value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
10926Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
10927@value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
10928both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
d4f3574e 10929@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
104c1213
JM
10930
10931@table @code
10932@item timeout @var{args}
10933@kindex remotetimeout
d4f3574e 10934@value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
104c1213
JM
10935This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
10936seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
10937@end table
10938
10939@kindex Compiling
d4f3574e
SS
10940When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
10941information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
10942load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
10943@samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
104c1213
JM
10944
10945@example
10946sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
10947@end example
10948
d4f3574e 10949You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
104c1213
JM
10950
10951@example
10952sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
10953@end example
10954
10955@kindex Running
10956Once you have set
10957your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
d4f3574e 10958run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
104c1213
JM
10959(or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
10960
10961@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
10962
10963@example
10964(gdbslet)
10965@end example
10966
10967@menu
10968* Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
10969* Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
10970* Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
10971* Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
10972@end menu
10973
10974@node Sparclet File
10975@subsubsection Setting file to debug
10976
10977The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
10978
10979@example
10980(gdbslet) file prog
10981@end example
10982
10983@need 1000
10984@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
10985@value{GDBN} locates
10986the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
10987path.
10988If the file was compiled with debug information (option "-g"), source
10989files will be searched as well.
10990@value{GDBN} locates
10991the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
10992path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}).
10993If it fails
10994to find a file, it displays a message such as:
10995
10996@example
10997prog: No such file or directory.
10998@end example
10999
11000When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
11001the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
11002@code{target} command again.
11003
11004@node Sparclet Connection
11005@subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
11006
11007The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
11008To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
11009
11010@example
11011(gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
11012Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
11013main () at ../prog.c:3
11014@end example
11015
11016@need 750
11017@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
11018
d4f3574e 11019@example
104c1213 11020Connected to ttya.
d4f3574e 11021@end example
104c1213
JM
11022
11023@node Sparclet Download
11024@subsubsection Sparclet download
11025
11026@cindex download to Sparclet
11027Once connected to the Sparclet target,
11028you can use the @value{GDBN}
11029@code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
11030The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
11031command.
11032Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
d4f3574e 11033address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
104c1213
JM
11034offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
11035of each of the file's sections.
11036For instance, if the program
11037@file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
11038and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
11039
11040@example
11041(gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
11042Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
11043@end example
11044
11045If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
11046to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
11047to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
11048
11049@node Sparclet Execution
11050@subsubsection Running and debugging
11051
11052@cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
11053You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
11054commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
11055manual for the list of commands.
11056
11057@example
11058(gdbslet) b main
11059Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
11060(gdbslet) run
11061Starting program: prog
11062Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
110633 char *symarg = 0;
11064(gdbslet) step
110654 char *execarg = "hello!";
11066(gdbslet)
11067@end example
11068
11069@node Sparclite
11070@subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
11071
11072@table @code
11073
11074@kindex target sparclite
11075@item target sparclite @var{dev}
11076Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
11077You must use an additional command to debug the program.
11078For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
11079remote protocol.
11080
11081@end table
11082
11083@node ST2000
11084@subsection Tandem ST2000
11085
2df3850c 11086@value{GDBN} may be used with a Tandem ST2000 phone switch, running Tandem's
104c1213
JM
11087STDBUG protocol.
11088
11089To connect your ST2000 to the host system, see the manufacturer's
11090manual. Once the ST2000 is physically attached, you can run:
11091
11092@example
11093target st2000 @var{dev} @var{speed}
11094@end example
11095
11096@noindent
11097to establish it as your debugging environment. @var{dev} is normally
11098the name of a serial device, such as @file{/dev/ttya}, connected to the
11099ST2000 via a serial line. You can instead specify @var{dev} as a TCP
11100connection (for example, to a serial line attached via a terminal
11101concentrator) using the syntax @code{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
11102
11103The @code{load} and @code{attach} commands are @emph{not} defined for
11104this target; you must load your program into the ST2000 as you normally
11105would for standalone operation. @value{GDBN} reads debugging information
11106(such as symbols) from a separate, debugging version of the program
11107available on your host computer.
11108@c FIXME!! This is terribly vague; what little content is here is
11109@c basically hearsay.
11110
11111@cindex ST2000 auxiliary commands
11112These auxiliary @value{GDBN} commands are available to help you with the ST2000
11113environment:
11114
11115@table @code
11116@item st2000 @var{command}
11117@kindex st2000 @var{cmd}
11118@cindex STDBUG commands (ST2000)
11119@cindex commands to STDBUG (ST2000)
11120Send a @var{command} to the STDBUG monitor. See the manufacturer's
11121manual for available commands.
11122
11123@item connect
11124@cindex connect (to STDBUG)
11125Connect the controlling terminal to the STDBUG command monitor. When
11126you are done interacting with STDBUG, typing either of two character
11127sequences gets you back to the @value{GDBN} command prompt:
11128@kbd{@key{RET}~.} (Return, followed by tilde and period) or
11129@kbd{@key{RET}~@key{C-d}} (Return, followed by tilde and control-D).
11130@end table
11131
11132@node Z8000
11133@subsection Zilog Z8000
11134
11135@cindex Z8000
11136@cindex simulator, Z8000
11137@cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
11138
11139When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
11140a Z8000 simulator.
11141
11142For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
11143unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
11144segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
11145appropriate by inspecting the object code.
11146
11147@table @code
11148@item target sim @var{args}
11149@kindex sim
d4f3574e 11150@kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
104c1213
JM
11151Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
11152options, specify them via @var{args}.
11153@end table
11154
11155@noindent
11156After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
11157CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
11158@code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
11159to run your program, and so on.
11160
d4f3574e
SS
11161As well as making available all the usual machine registers
11162(@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
11163additional items of information as specially named registers:
104c1213
JM
11164
11165@table @code
11166
11167@item cycles
11168Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
11169
11170@item insts
11171Counts instructions run in the simulator.
11172
11173@item time
11174Execution time in 60ths of a second.
11175
11176@end table
11177
11178You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
11179conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
11180conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
11181simulated clock ticks.
11182
11183@node Architectures
11184@section Architectures
11185
11186This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
2df3850c 11187all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
104c1213
JM
11188
11189@menu
11190* A29K::
11191* Alpha::
11192* MIPS::
11193@end menu
11194
11195@node A29K
11196@subsection A29K
11197
11198@table @code
11199
11200@kindex set rstack_high_address
11201@cindex AMD 29K register stack
11202@cindex register stack, AMD29K
11203@item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
11204On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
d4f3574e 11205@dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
104c1213
JM
11206extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
11207stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
11208memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
11209this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
11210the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
11211address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
11212hexadecimal.
11213
11214@kindex show rstack_high_address
11215@item show rstack_high_address
11216Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
11217processors.
11218
11219@end table
11220
11221@node Alpha
11222@subsection Alpha
11223
11224See the following section.
11225
11226@node MIPS
11227@subsection MIPS
11228
11229@cindex stack on Alpha
11230@cindex stack on MIPS
11231@cindex Alpha stack
11232@cindex MIPS stack
11233Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
11234sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
11235find the beginning of a function.
11236
11237@cindex response time, MIPS debugging
11238To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
11239@value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
11240you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
11241commands:
11242
11243@table @code
11244@cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha,MIPS)
11245@item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
11246Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
11247search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
11248default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
11249larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
11250and therefore the longer it takes to run.
11251
11252@item show heuristic-fence-post
11253Display the current limit.
11254@end table
11255
11256@noindent
11257These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
11258for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
11259
11260
c906108c
SS
11261@node Controlling GDB
11262@chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
11263
53a5351d
JM
11264You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
11265@code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
d4f3574e 11266data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}. Other settings are
53a5351d 11267described here.
c906108c
SS
11268
11269@menu
11270* Prompt:: Prompt
11271* Editing:: Command editing
11272* History:: Command history
11273* Screen Size:: Screen size
11274* Numbers:: Numbers
11275* Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
11276@end menu
11277
53a5351d 11278@node Prompt
c906108c
SS
11279@section Prompt
11280
11281@cindex prompt
11282
11283@value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
11284called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
11285can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
11286instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
11287the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
11288which one you are talking to.
11289
d4f3574e 11290@emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
c906108c
SS
11291prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
11292or a prompt that does not.
11293
11294@table @code
11295@kindex set prompt
11296@item set prompt @var{newprompt}
11297Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
11298
11299@kindex show prompt
11300@item show prompt
11301Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
11302@end table
11303
53a5351d 11304@node Editing
c906108c
SS
11305@section Command editing
11306@cindex readline
11307@cindex command line editing
11308
11309@value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{readline} interface. This
11310@sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
11311command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
11312or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
11313substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
11314debugging sessions.
11315
11316You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
11317command @code{set}.
11318
11319@table @code
11320@kindex set editing
11321@cindex editing
11322@item set editing
11323@itemx set editing on
11324Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
11325
11326@item set editing off
11327Disable command line editing.
11328
11329@kindex show editing
11330@item show editing
11331Show whether command line editing is enabled.
11332@end table
11333
53a5351d 11334@node History
c906108c
SS
11335@section Command history
11336
11337@value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
11338debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
11339happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
11340history facility.
11341
11342@table @code
11343@cindex history substitution
11344@cindex history file
11345@kindex set history filename
11346@kindex GDBHISTFILE
11347@item set history filename @var{fname}
11348Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
11349This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
11350list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
11351exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
11352the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
11353to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
d4f3574e
SS
11354@file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
11355is not set.
c906108c
SS
11356
11357@cindex history save
11358@kindex set history save
11359@item set history save
11360@itemx set history save on
11361Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
11362@code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
11363
11364@item set history save off
11365Stop recording command history in a file.
11366
11367@cindex history size
11368@kindex set history size
11369@item set history size @var{size}
11370Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
11371This defaults to the value of the environment variable
11372@code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
11373@end table
11374
11375@cindex history expansion
11376History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
11377@ifset have-readline-appendices
11378@xref{Event Designators}.
11379@end ifset
11380
11381Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
11382is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
11383@code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
11384follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
11385a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
11386history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
11387@kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
11388
11389The commands to control history expansion are:
11390
11391@table @code
11392@kindex set history expansion
11393@item set history expansion on
11394@itemx set history expansion
11395Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
11396
11397@item set history expansion off
11398Disable history expansion.
11399
11400The readline code comes with more complete documentation of
11401editing and history expansion features. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs
11402or @code{vi} may wish to read it.
11403@ifset have-readline-appendices
11404@xref{Command Line Editing}.
11405@end ifset
11406
11407@c @group
11408@kindex show history
11409@item show history
11410@itemx show history filename
11411@itemx show history save
11412@itemx show history size
11413@itemx show history expansion
11414These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
11415@code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
11416@c @end group
11417@end table
11418
11419@table @code
11420@kindex show commands
11421@item show commands
11422Display the last ten commands in the command history.
11423
11424@item show commands @var{n}
11425Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
11426
11427@item show commands +
11428Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
11429@end table
11430
53a5351d 11431@node Screen Size
c906108c
SS
11432@section Screen size
11433@cindex size of screen
11434@cindex pauses in output
11435
11436Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
11437information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
11438@value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
11439output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
11440to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
11441determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
11442printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
11443rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
11444
d4f3574e
SS
11445Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
11446driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
c906108c 11447together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
d4f3574e 11448@code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
c906108c
SS
11449you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
11450width} commands:
11451
11452@table @code
11453@kindex set height
11454@kindex set width
11455@kindex show width
11456@kindex show height
11457@item set height @var{lpp}
11458@itemx show height
11459@itemx set width @var{cpl}
11460@itemx show width
11461These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
11462a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
11463commands display the current settings.
11464
11465If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
11466output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
11467file or to an editor buffer.
11468
11469Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
11470from wrapping its output.
11471@end table
11472
53a5351d 11473@node Numbers
c906108c
SS
11474@section Numbers
11475@cindex number representation
11476@cindex entering numbers
11477
2df3850c
JM
11478You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
11479@value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
11480@samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
11481begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that begin with none of these are, by
11482default, entered in base 10; likewise, the default display for
11483numbers---when no particular format is specified---is base 10. You can
11484change the default base for both input and output with the @code{set
11485radix} command.
c906108c
SS
11486
11487@table @code
11488@kindex set input-radix
11489@item set input-radix @var{base}
11490Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
11491for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
11492specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix; for
11493example, any of
11494
11495@smallexample
11496set radix 012
11497set radix 10.
11498set radix 0xa
11499@end smallexample
11500
11501@noindent
11502sets the base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set radix 10}
11503leaves the radix unchanged no matter what it was.
11504
11505@kindex set output-radix
11506@item set output-radix @var{base}
11507Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
11508for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
11509specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix.
11510
11511@kindex show input-radix
11512@item show input-radix
11513Display the current default base for numeric input.
11514
11515@kindex show output-radix
11516@item show output-radix
11517Display the current default base for numeric display.
11518@end table
11519
53a5351d 11520@node Messages/Warnings
c906108c
SS
11521@section Optional warnings and messages
11522
2df3850c
JM
11523By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
11524running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
11525command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
11526internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
c906108c
SS
11527
11528Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
11529which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
11530see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
11531
11532@table @code
11533@kindex set verbose
11534@item set verbose on
11535Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
11536
11537@item set verbose off
11538Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
11539
11540@kindex show verbose
11541@item show verbose
11542Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
11543@end table
11544
2df3850c
JM
11545By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
11546object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
11547find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors reading
11548symbol files}).
c906108c
SS
11549
11550@table @code
2df3850c 11551
c906108c
SS
11552@kindex set complaints
11553@item set complaints @var{limit}
2df3850c
JM
11554Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
11555unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
11556@var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
11557to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
c906108c
SS
11558
11559@kindex show complaints
11560@item show complaints
11561Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
2df3850c 11562
c906108c
SS
11563@end table
11564
11565By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
11566lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
11567you try to run a program which is already running:
11568
11569@example
11570(@value{GDBP}) run
11571The program being debugged has been started already.
11572Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
11573@end example
11574
11575If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
11576commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
11577
11578@table @code
2df3850c 11579
c906108c
SS
11580@kindex set confirm
11581@cindex flinching
11582@cindex confirmation
11583@cindex stupid questions
11584@item set confirm off
11585Disables confirmation requests.
11586
11587@item set confirm on
11588Enables confirmation requests (the default).
11589
11590@kindex show confirm
11591@item show confirm
11592Displays state of confirmation requests.
2df3850c 11593
c906108c
SS
11594@end table
11595
53a5351d 11596@node Sequences
c906108c
SS
11597@chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
11598
11599Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
2df3850c
JM
11600command lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
11601commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
11602files.
c906108c
SS
11603
11604@menu
11605* Define:: User-defined commands
11606* Hooks:: User-defined command hooks
11607* Command Files:: Command files
11608* Output:: Commands for controlled output
11609@end menu
11610
53a5351d 11611@node Define
c906108c
SS
11612@section User-defined commands
11613
11614@cindex user-defined command
2df3850c
JM
11615A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
11616which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
11617@code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
11618separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
11619via @var{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
c906108c
SS
11620
11621@smallexample
11622define adder
11623 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
11624@end smallexample
11625
d4f3574e
SS
11626@noindent
11627To execute the command use:
c906108c
SS
11628
11629@smallexample
11630adder 1 2 3
11631@end smallexample
11632
d4f3574e
SS
11633@noindent
11634This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
c906108c
SS
11635its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
11636reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
11637functions calls.
11638
11639@table @code
2df3850c 11640
c906108c
SS
11641@kindex define
11642@item define @var{commandname}
11643Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
11644by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
11645
11646The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
11647which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
11648commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
11649
11650@kindex if
11651@kindex else
11652@item if
11653Takes a single argument, which is an expression to evaluate.
11654It is followed by a series of commands that are executed
11655only if the expression is true (nonzero).
11656There can then optionally be a line @code{else}, followed
11657by a series of commands that are only executed if the expression
11658was false. The end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
11659
11660@kindex while
11661@item while
11662The syntax is similar to @code{if}: the command takes a single argument,
11663which is an expression to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to
11664execute, one per line, terminated by an @code{end}.
11665The commands are executed repeatedly as long as the expression
11666evaluates to true.
11667
11668@kindex document
11669@item document @var{commandname}
11670Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
11671accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
11672defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
11673reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
11674After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
11675@var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
11676
11677You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
11678documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
11679does not change the documentation.
11680
11681@kindex help user-defined
11682@item help user-defined
11683List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
11684(if any) for each.
11685
11686@kindex show user
11687@item show user
11688@itemx show user @var{commandname}
2df3850c
JM
11689Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
11690not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
c906108c 11691definitions for all user-defined commands.
2df3850c 11692
c906108c
SS
11693@end table
11694
11695When user-defined commands are executed, the
11696commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
11697stops execution of the user-defined command.
11698
11699If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
11700without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
11701commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
11702messages when used in a user-defined command.
11703
53a5351d 11704@node Hooks
c906108c 11705@section User-defined command hooks
d4f3574e
SS
11706@cindex command hooks
11707@cindex hooks, for commands
c906108c
SS
11708
11709You may define @emph{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
11710command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
11711command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
11712before that command.
11713
d4f3574e 11714@kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
c906108c
SS
11715In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
11716(@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
11717execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
11718displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
11719
c906108c
SS
11720For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
11721single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
11722you could define:
11723
11724@example
11725define hook-stop
11726handle SIGALRM nopass
11727end
11728
11729define hook-run
11730handle SIGALRM pass
11731end
11732
11733define hook-continue
11734handle SIGLARM pass
11735end
11736@end example
c906108c
SS
11737
11738You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
11739not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
11740name, e.g. @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
11741@c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
11742@c or not?
11743If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
11744@value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
11745(before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
11746
11747If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
11748get a warning from the @code{define} command.
11749
53a5351d 11750@node Command Files
c906108c
SS
11751@section Command files
11752
11753@cindex command files
11754A command file for @value{GDBN} is a file of lines that are @value{GDBN}
11755commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may also be included.
11756An empty line in a command file does nothing; it does not mean to repeat
11757the last command, as it would from the terminal.
11758
11759@cindex init file
11760@cindex @file{.gdbinit}
d4f3574e 11761@cindex @file{gdb.ini}
c906108c
SS
11762When you start @value{GDBN}, it automatically executes commands from its
11763@dfn{init files}. These are files named @file{.gdbinit} on Unix, or
11764@file{gdb.ini} on DOS/Windows. @value{GDBN} reads the init file (if
d4f3574e 11765any) in your home directory@footnote{On DOS/Windows systems, the home
2df3850c
JM
11766directory is the one pointed to by the @code{HOME} environment
11767variable.}, then processes command line options and operands, and then
11768reads the init file (if any) in the current working directory. This is
11769so the init file in your home directory can set options (such as
11770@code{set complaints}) which affect the processing of the command line
11771options and operands. The init files are not executed if you use the
11772@samp{-nx} option; @pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing modes}.
c906108c 11773
c906108c
SS
11774@cindex init file name
11775On some configurations of @value{GDBN}, the init file is known by a
11776different name (these are typically environments where a specialized
11777form of @value{GDBN} may need to coexist with other forms, hence a
11778different name for the specialized version's init file). These are the
11779environments with special init file names:
11780
11781@kindex .vxgdbinit
11782@itemize @bullet
11783@item
11784VxWorks (Wind River Systems real-time OS): @samp{.vxgdbinit}
11785
11786@kindex .os68gdbinit
11787@item
11788OS68K (Enea Data Systems real-time OS): @samp{.os68gdbinit}
11789
11790@kindex .esgdbinit
11791@item
11792ES-1800 (Ericsson Telecom AB M68000 emulator): @samp{.esgdbinit}
11793@end itemize
c906108c
SS
11794
11795You can also request the execution of a command file with the
11796@code{source} command:
11797
11798@table @code
11799@kindex source
11800@item source @var{filename}
11801Execute the command file @var{filename}.
11802@end table
11803
11804The lines in a command file are executed sequentially. They are not
11805printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates execution
11806of the command file.
11807
11808Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
11809without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
11810normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
11811when called from command files.
11812
53a5351d 11813@node Output
c906108c
SS
11814@section Commands for controlled output
11815
11816During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
11817@value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
11818explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
11819describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
11820want.
11821
11822@table @code
11823@kindex echo
11824@item echo @var{text}
11825@c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
11826@c because it is not in ANSI.
11827Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
11828@var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
11829newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
11830In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
11831by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
11832string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
11833trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
11834To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
11835@samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
11836
11837A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
11838the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
11839
11840@example
11841echo This is some text\n\
11842which is continued\n\
11843onto several lines.\n
11844@end example
11845
11846produces the same output as
11847
11848@example
11849echo This is some text\n
11850echo which is continued\n
11851echo onto several lines.\n
11852@end example
11853
11854@kindex output
11855@item output @var{expression}
11856Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
11857newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
11858value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
11859on expressions.
11860
11861@item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
11862Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
11863the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
11864formats}, for more information.
11865
11866@kindex printf
11867@item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
11868Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
11869@var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
11870either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
11871@var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
11872subroutine
d4f3574e
SS
11873@c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
11874@c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
11875@c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
11876@c supported.
c906108c
SS
11877
11878@example
11879printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
11880@end example
11881
11882For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
11883
11884@smallexample
11885printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
11886@end smallexample
11887
11888The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
11889string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
11890letter.
11891@end table
11892
53a5351d 11893@node Emacs
c906108c
SS
11894@chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
11895
11896@cindex Emacs
11897@cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
11898A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
11899edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
11900@value{GDBN}.
11901
11902To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
11903executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
11904@value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
11905created Emacs buffer.
53a5351d 11906@c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
c906108c
SS
11907
11908Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
11909things:
11910
11911@itemize @bullet
11912@item
11913All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
11914@end itemize
11915
11916This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
11917and output done by the program you are debugging.
11918
11919This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
11920commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
11921in this way.
11922
11923All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
11924with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
11925way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
11926stop.
11927
11928@itemize @bullet
11929@item
11930@value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
11931@end itemize
11932
11933Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
11934source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
11935left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
11936source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
11937and the source.
11938
11939Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
11940usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
11941
11942@quotation
11943@emph{Warning:} If the directory where your program resides is not your
11944current directory, it can be easy to confuse Emacs about the location of
11945the source files, in which case the auxiliary display buffer does not
11946appear to show your source. @value{GDBN} can find programs by searching your
11947environment's @code{PATH} variable, so the @value{GDBN} input and output
11948session proceeds normally; but Emacs does not get enough information
11949back from @value{GDBN} to locate the source files in this situation. To
11950avoid this problem, either start @value{GDBN} mode from the directory where
11951your program resides, or specify an absolute file name when prompted for the
11952@kbd{M-x gdb} argument.
11953
11954A similar confusion can result if you use the @value{GDBN} @code{file} command to
11955switch to debugging a program in some other location, from an existing
11956@value{GDBN} buffer in Emacs.
11957@end quotation
11958
11959By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If
11960you need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you keep
11961several configurations around, with different names) you can set the
11962Emacs variable @code{gdb-command-name}; for example,
11963
11964@example
11965(setq gdb-command-name "mygdb")
11966@end example
11967
11968@noindent
d4f3574e 11969(preceded by @kbd{M-:} or @kbd{ESC :}, or typed in the @code{*scratch*} buffer, or
c906108c
SS
11970in your @file{.emacs} file) makes Emacs call the program named
11971``@code{mygdb}'' instead.
11972
11973In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
11974addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
11975
11976@table @kbd
11977@item C-h m
11978Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
11979
11980@item M-s
11981Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
11982update the display window to show the current file and location.
11983
11984@item M-n
11985Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
11986calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
11987to show the current file and location.
11988
11989@item M-i
11990Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
11991display window accordingly.
11992
11993@item M-x gdb-nexti
11994Execute to next instruction, using the @value{GDBN} @code{nexti} command; update
11995display window accordingly.
11996
11997@item C-c C-f
11998Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
11999@code{finish} command.
12000
12001@item M-c
12002Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
12003command.
12004
12005@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-p}.
12006
12007@item M-u
12008Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
12009(@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
12010like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
12011
12012@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-u}.
12013
12014@item M-d
12015Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
12016@value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
12017
12018@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-d}.
12019
12020@item C-x &
12021Read the number where the cursor is positioned, and insert it at the end
12022of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer. For example, if you wish to disassemble code
12023around an address that was displayed earlier, type @kbd{disassemble};
12024then move the cursor to the address display, and pick up the
12025argument for @code{disassemble} by typing @kbd{C-x &}.
12026
12027You can customize this further by defining elements of the list
12028@code{gdb-print-command}; once it is defined, you can format or
12029otherwise process numbers picked up by @kbd{C-x &} before they are
12030inserted. A numeric argument to @kbd{C-x &} indicates that you
12031wish special formatting, and also acts as an index to pick an element of the
12032list. If the list element is a string, the number to be inserted is
12033formatted using the Emacs function @code{format}; otherwise the number
12034is passed as an argument to the corresponding list element.
12035@end table
12036
12037In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x SPC} (@code{gdb-break})
12038tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
12039
12040If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
12041it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
12042request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
12043the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
12044frame.
12045
12046The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
12047which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
12048the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
12049communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
12050delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
12051to correspond properly with the code.
12052
12053@c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
12054@c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
12055@ignore
12056@kindex Emacs Epoch environment
12057@kindex Epoch
12058@kindex inspect
12059
12060Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
12061called the @code{epoch}
12062environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
12063@code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
12064each value is printed in its own window.
12065@end ignore
c906108c 12066
d700128c
EZ
12067@include annotate.texi
12068
c906108c 12069@node GDB Bugs
c906108c
SS
12070@chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
12071@cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
12072@cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
12073
12074Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
12075
12076Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
12077may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
12078the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
12079reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
12080
12081In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
12082information that enables us to fix the bug.
12083
12084@menu
12085* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
12086* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
12087@end menu
12088
53a5351d 12089@node Bug Criteria
c906108c
SS
12090@section Have you found a bug?
12091@cindex bug criteria
12092
12093If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
12094
12095@itemize @bullet
12096@cindex fatal signal
12097@cindex debugger crash
12098@cindex crash of debugger
12099@item
12100If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
12101@value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
12102
12103@cindex error on valid input
12104@item
12105If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
12106bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
12107somewhere in the connection to the target.)
12108
12109@cindex invalid input
12110@item
12111If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
12112that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
12113``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
12114for traditional practice''.
12115
12116@item
12117If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
12118for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
12119@end itemize
12120
53a5351d 12121@node Bug Reporting
c906108c
SS
12122@section How to report bugs
12123@cindex bug reports
12124@cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
12125
c906108c
SS
12126A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
12127If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
12128contact that organization first.
12129
12130You can find contact information for many support companies and
12131individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
12132distribution.
12133@c should add a web page ref...
12134
12135In any event, we also recommend that you send bug reports for
12136@value{GDBN} to this addresses:
12137
12138@example
d4f3574e 12139bug-gdb@@gnu.org
c906108c
SS
12140@end example
12141
12142@strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
d4f3574e 12143@samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
c906108c
SS
12144not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
12145@samp{bug-gdb}.
12146
12147The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
12148serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
12149the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
12150newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
12151problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
12152path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
12153we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
12154bug reports to the mailing list.
12155
12156As a last resort, send bug reports on paper to:
12157
12158@example
12159@sc{gnu} Debugger Bugs
12160Free Software Foundation Inc.
1216159 Temple Place - Suite 330
12162Boston, MA 02111-1307
12163USA
12164@end example
c906108c
SS
12165
12166The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
12167@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
12168fact or leave it out, state it!
12169
12170Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
12171problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
12172assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
12173Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
12174stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
12175name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
12176of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
12177the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
12178easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
12179
12180Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
12181bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
12182you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
12183self-contained.
12184
12185Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
12186bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
12187@emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
12188bugs properly.
12189
12190To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
12191
12192@itemize @bullet
12193@item
12194The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
12195with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
12196version}.
12197
12198Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
12199the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
12200
12201@item
12202The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
12203version number.
12204
c906108c
SS
12205@item
12206What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.
12207``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
c906108c
SS
12208
12209@item
12210What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
12211debugging---e.g. ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
12212C Compiler''. For GCC, you can say @code{gcc --version} to get this
12213information; for other compilers, see the documentation for those
12214compilers.
12215
12216@item
12217The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
12218observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
12219you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
12220Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
12221
12222If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
12223and then we might not encounter the bug.
12224
12225@item
12226A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
12227reproduce the bug.
12228
12229@item
12230A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
12231incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
12232
12233Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
12234will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
12235not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
12236a chance to make a mistake.
12237
12238Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
12239say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
12240copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
12241the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
12242crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
12243ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
12244us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
12245to draw any conclusion from our observations.
12246
c906108c
SS
12247@item
12248If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
12249diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
12250it by context, not by line number.
12251
12252The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
12253sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
53a5351d 12254
c906108c
SS
12255@end itemize
12256
12257Here are some things that are not necessary:
12258
12259@itemize @bullet
12260@item
12261A description of the envelope of the bug.
12262
12263Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
12264which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
12265changes will not affect it.
12266
12267This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
12268will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
12269with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
12270We recommend that you save your time for something else.
12271
12272Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
12273of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
12274output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
12275less time, and so on.
12276
12277However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
12278report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
12279
12280@item
12281A patch for the bug.
12282
12283A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
12284the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
12285a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
12286to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
12287
12288Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
12289construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
12290through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
12291to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
12292
12293And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
12294patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
12295help us to understand.
12296
12297@item
12298A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
12299
12300Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
12301things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
12302@end itemize
12303
12304@c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
12305@c and consists of the two following files:
12306@c rluser.texinfo
7be570e7 12307@c inc-hist.texinfo
c906108c
SS
12308@c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
12309@c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
12310@include rluser.texinfo
7be570e7 12311@include inc-hist.texinfo
c906108c
SS
12312
12313
c906108c 12314@node Formatting Documentation
c906108c
SS
12315@appendix Formatting Documentation
12316
12317@cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
12318@cindex reference card
12319The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
12320for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
12321subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
12322@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
12323release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
12324you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
12325
12326The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
12327can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
12328
12329@example
12330make refcard.dvi
12331@end example
12332
12333The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
12334mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
12335that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
12336high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
12337your @sc{dvi} output program.
12338
12339@cindex documentation
12340
12341All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
12342distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
12343a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
12344on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
12345formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
12346and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
12347
12348@value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
12349version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
12350file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
12351subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
12352necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
12353but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
12354Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
12355@sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
12356
12357If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
12358Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
12359@code{makeinfo}.
12360
12361If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
12362@value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
12363version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
12364
12365@example
12366cd gdb
12367make gdb.info
12368@end example
12369
12370If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
12371a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
12372Texinfo definitions file.
12373
12374@TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
12375produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
12376document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
12377has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
12378command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
12379(for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
12380require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
12381
12382@TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
12383@file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
12384written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
12385typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
12386and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
12387directory.
12388
12389If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
12390typeset and print this manual. First switch to the the @file{gdb}
12391subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
12392@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
12393
12394@example
12395make gdb.dvi
12396@end example
12397
12398Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
c906108c 12399
53a5351d 12400@node Installing GDB
c906108c
SS
12401@appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
12402@cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
12403@cindex installation
12404
c906108c
SS
12405@value{GDBN} comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process
12406of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
12407build the @code{gdb} program.
12408@iftex
12409@c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
12410@footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
12411look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
12412installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
12413@end iftex
12414
12415The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
12416@value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
12417appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
12418
12419For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
12420@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
12421
12422@table @code
12423@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
12424script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
12425
12426@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
12427the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
12428
12429@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
12430source for the Binary File Descriptor library
12431
12432@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
12433@sc{gnu} include files
12434
12435@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
12436source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
12437
12438@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
12439source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
12440
12441@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
12442source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
12443
12444@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
12445source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
12446
12447@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
12448source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
12449@end table
12450
12451The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @code{configure}
12452from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
12453this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
12454
12455First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
12456if you are not already in it; then run @code{configure}. Pass the
12457identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
12458argument.
12459
12460For example:
12461
12462@example
12463cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
12464./configure @var{host}
12465make
12466@end example
12467
12468@noindent
12469where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
12470@samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
12471(You can often leave off @var{host}; @code{configure} tries to guess the
12472correct value by examining your system.)
12473
12474Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
12475@file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
12476libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
12477binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
12478
12479@need 750
12480@code{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
12481system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
12482shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
12483
12484@example
12485sh configure @var{host}
12486@end example
12487
12488If you run @code{configure} from a directory that contains source
12489directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
12490@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, @code{configure}
12491creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
12492you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
12493
12494You can run the @code{configure} script from any of the
12495subordinate directories in the @value{GDBN} distribution if you only want to
12496configure that subdirectory, but be sure to specify a path to it.
12497
12498For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, type the following to configure only
12499the @code{bfd} subdirectory:
12500
12501@example
12502@group
12503cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
12504../configure @var{host}
12505@end group
12506@end example
12507
12508You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
12509However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
12510the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
12511that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
12512let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
12513
12514@menu
12515* Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
12516* Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
12517* Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
12518@end menu
12519
53a5351d 12520@node Separate Objdir
c906108c
SS
12521@section Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
12522
12523If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
12524you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
12525host and target. @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by
12526allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
12527rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
12528handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
12529@code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
12530program specified there.
12531
12532To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @code{configure}
12533with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
12534(You also need to specify a path to find @code{configure}
12535itself from your working directory. If the path to @code{configure}
12536would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
12537the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
12538
12539For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
12540separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
12541
12542@example
12543@group
12544cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
12545mkdir ../gdb-sun4
12546cd ../gdb-sun4
12547../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
12548make
12549@end group
12550@end example
12551
12552When @code{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
12553directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
12554(and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
12555the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
12556directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
12557@file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
12558
12559One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
12560directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
12561@value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
12562programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
12563You specify a cross-debugging target by
12564giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}.
12565
12566When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
12567it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
12568called @code{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
12569
12570The @code{Makefile} that @code{configure} generates in each source
12571directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
12572directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
12573directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
12574will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
12575
12576When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
12577directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
12578if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
12579with each other.
12580
53a5351d 12581@node Config Names
c906108c
SS
12582@section Specifying names for hosts and targets
12583
12584The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure}
12585script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
12586aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
12587of information in the following pattern:
12588
12589@example
12590@var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
12591@end example
12592
12593For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
12594or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
12595option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
12596
12597The @code{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
12598any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
12599aliases. @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
12600@code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
12601script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
12602abbreviations---for example:
12603
12604@smallexample
12605% sh config.sub i386-linux
12606i386-pc-linux-gnu
12607% sh config.sub alpha-linux
12608alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
12609% sh config.sub hp9k700
12610hppa1.1-hp-hpux
12611% sh config.sub sun4
12612sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
12613% sh config.sub sun3
12614m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
12615% sh config.sub i986v
12616Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
12617@end smallexample
12618
12619@noindent
12620@code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
12621directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
12622
53a5351d 12623@node Configure Options
c906108c
SS
12624@section @code{configure} options
12625
12626Here is a summary of the @code{configure} options and arguments that
12627are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @code{configure} also has
12628several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
12629Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @code{configure}.
12630
12631@example
12632configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
12633 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
12634 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
12635 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
12636 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
12637 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
12638 @var{host}
12639@end example
12640
12641@noindent
12642You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
12643@samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
12644@samp{--}.
12645
12646@table @code
12647@item --help
12648Display a quick summary of how to invoke @code{configure}.
12649
12650@item --prefix=@var{dir}
12651Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
12652@file{@var{dir}}.
12653
12654@item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
12655Configure the source to install programs under directory
12656@file{@var{dir}}.
12657
12658@c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
12659@need 2000
12660@item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
12661@strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
12662@code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
12663Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
12664@value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
12665build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
12666directories. @code{configure} writes configuration specific files in
12667the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
12668directory @var{dirname}. @code{configure} creates directories under
12669the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
12670@var{dirname}.
12671
12672@item --norecursion
12673Configure only the directory level where @code{configure} is executed; do not
12674propagate configuration to subdirectories.
12675
12676@item --target=@var{target}
12677Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
12678@var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
12679programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
12680
12681There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
12682
12683@item @var{host} @dots{}
12684Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
12685
12686There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
12687@end table
12688
12689There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
12690needed for special purposes only.
c906108c 12691
53a5351d 12692@node Index
c906108c
SS
12693@unnumbered Index
12694
12695@printindex cp
12696
12697@tex
12698% I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
12699% meantime:
12700\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
12701\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
12702\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
12703\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
12704\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
12705\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
12706\centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
12707\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
12708\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
12709\page\colophon
12710% Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
12711@end tex
12712
12713@contents
12714@bye
This page took 0.758045 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.